1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */ 2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H 3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H 4 /* 5 * 802.11 device and configuration interface 6 * 7 * Copyright 2006-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net> 8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH 9 * Copyright 2015-2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH 10 * Copyright (C) 2018-2021, 2023 Intel Corporation 11 */ 12 13 #include <linux/ethtool.h> 14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h> 15 #include <linux/netdevice.h> 16 #include <linux/debugfs.h> 17 #include <linux/list.h> 18 #include <linux/bug.h> 19 #include <linux/netlink.h> 20 #include <linux/skbuff.h> 21 #include <linux/nl80211.h> 22 #include <linux/if_ether.h> 23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h> 24 #include <linux/net.h> 25 #include <linux/rfkill.h> 26 #include <net/regulatory.h> 27 28 /** 29 * DOC: Introduction 30 * 31 * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges 32 * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated 33 * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used 34 * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent 35 * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers 36 * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely. 37 * 38 * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum 39 * use restrictions. 40 */ 41 42 43 /** 44 * DOC: Device registration 45 * 46 * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device 47 * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs 48 * described below. 49 * 50 * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each 51 * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each 52 * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with 53 * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's 54 * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes 55 * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the 56 * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating 57 * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the 58 * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful. 59 * 60 * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has 61 * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and 62 * structures here describe these capabilities in detail. 63 */ 64 65 struct wiphy; 66 67 /* 68 * wireless hardware capability structures 69 */ 70 71 /** 72 * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags 73 * 74 * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code. 75 * 76 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled. 77 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes 78 * sending probe requests or beaconing. 79 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD: Power spectral density (in dBm) is set for this 80 * channel. 81 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel. 82 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel 83 * is not permitted. 84 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel 85 * is not permitted. 86 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel. 87 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band, 88 * this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this 89 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 90 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 91 * restrictions. 92 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band, 93 * this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this 94 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 95 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 96 * restrictions. 97 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY 98 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT 99 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 100 * on this channel. 101 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted 102 * on this channel. 103 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel. 104 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted 105 * on this channel. 106 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted 107 * on this channel. 108 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted 109 * on this channel. 110 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted 111 * on this channel. 112 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted 113 * on this channel. 114 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ: If the driver supports 320 MHz on the band, 115 * this flag indicates that a 320 MHz channel cannot use this 116 * channel as the control or any of the secondary channels. 117 * This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth 118 * restrictions. 119 * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT: EHT operation is not permitted on this channel. 120 */ 121 enum ieee80211_channel_flags { 122 IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED = 1<<0, 123 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR = 1<<1, 124 IEEE80211_CHAN_PSD = 1<<2, 125 IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR = 1<<3, 126 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS = 1<<4, 127 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS = 1<<5, 128 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM = 1<<6, 129 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ = 1<<7, 130 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ = 1<<8, 131 IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY = 1<<9, 132 IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT = 1<<10, 133 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ = 1<<11, 134 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ = 1<<12, 135 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE = 1<<13, 136 IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ = 1<<14, 137 IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ = 1<<15, 138 IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ = 1<<16, 139 IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ = 1<<17, 140 IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ = 1<<18, 141 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_320MHZ = 1<<19, 142 IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_EHT = 1<<20, 143 }; 144 145 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \ 146 (IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS) 147 148 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS 60000 149 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS (30 * 60 * 1000) 150 151 /** 152 * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition 153 * 154 * This structure describes a single channel for use 155 * with cfg80211. 156 * 157 * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz 158 * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz 159 * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel 160 * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags. 161 * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory 162 * code to support devices with additional restrictions 163 * @band: band this channel belongs to. 164 * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi 165 * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm) 166 * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm) 167 * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon 168 * has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon() 169 * to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band. 170 * @orig_mag: internal use 171 * @orig_mpwr: internal use 172 * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required 173 * on this channel. 174 * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 175 * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels. 176 * @psd: power spectral density (in dBm) 177 */ 178 struct ieee80211_channel { 179 enum nl80211_band band; 180 u32 center_freq; 181 u16 freq_offset; 182 u16 hw_value; 183 u32 flags; 184 int max_antenna_gain; 185 int max_power; 186 int max_reg_power; 187 bool beacon_found; 188 u32 orig_flags; 189 int orig_mag, orig_mpwr; 190 enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state; 191 unsigned long dfs_state_entered; 192 unsigned int dfs_cac_ms; 193 s8 psd; 194 }; 195 196 /** 197 * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags 198 * 199 * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured 200 * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for 201 * different bands/PHY modes. 202 * 203 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short 204 * preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and 205 * with CCK rates. 206 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 207 * when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the 208 * core code when registering the wiphy. 209 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 210 * when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 211 * core code when registering the wiphy. 212 * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate 213 * when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the 214 * core code when registering the wiphy. 215 * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode. 216 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode 217 * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode 218 */ 219 enum ieee80211_rate_flags { 220 IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<0, 221 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A = 1<<1, 222 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B = 1<<2, 223 IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G = 1<<3, 224 IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G = 1<<4, 225 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ = 1<<5, 226 IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ = 1<<6, 227 }; 228 229 /** 230 * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter 231 * 232 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS 233 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS 234 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS 235 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS 236 * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type 237 */ 238 enum ieee80211_bss_type { 239 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS, 240 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS, 241 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 242 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS, 243 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY 244 }; 245 246 /** 247 * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter 248 * 249 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set 250 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear 251 * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting 252 */ 253 enum ieee80211_privacy { 254 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON, 255 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF, 256 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY 257 }; 258 259 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x) \ 260 ((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF) 261 262 /** 263 * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition 264 * 265 * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can 266 * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short 267 * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are 268 * passed around. 269 * 270 * @flags: rate-specific flags from &enum ieee80211_rate_flags 271 * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps 272 * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate 273 * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when 274 * short preamble is used 275 */ 276 struct ieee80211_rate { 277 u32 flags; 278 u16 bitrate; 279 u16 hw_value, hw_value_short; 280 }; 281 282 /** 283 * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse 284 * 285 * @enable: is the feature enabled. 286 * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element. 287 * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset 288 * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use 289 * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use 290 * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by 291 * members of the SRG 292 * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values 293 * used by members of the SRG 294 */ 295 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd { 296 bool enable; 297 u8 sr_ctrl; 298 u8 non_srg_max_offset; 299 u8 min_offset; 300 u8 max_offset; 301 u8 bss_color_bitmap[8]; 302 u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8]; 303 }; 304 305 /** 306 * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring 307 * 308 * @color: the current color. 309 * @enabled: HE BSS color is used 310 * @partial: define the AID equation. 311 */ 312 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color { 313 u8 color; 314 bool enabled; 315 bool partial; 316 }; 317 318 /** 319 * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities 320 * 321 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 322 * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA. 323 * 324 * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA 325 * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec 326 * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor 327 * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing 328 * @mcs: Supported MCS rates 329 */ 330 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap { 331 u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */ 332 bool ht_supported; 333 u8 ampdu_factor; 334 u8 ampdu_density; 335 struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs; 336 }; 337 338 /** 339 * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities 340 * 341 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 342 * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA. 343 * 344 * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA 345 * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec 346 * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates 347 */ 348 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap { 349 bool vht_supported; 350 u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */ 351 struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs; 352 }; 353 354 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 25 355 356 /** 357 * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities 358 * 359 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 360 * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA. 361 * 362 * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid. 363 * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element. 364 * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. 365 * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. 366 */ 367 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap { 368 bool has_he; 369 struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem; 370 struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp; 371 u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; 372 }; 373 374 /** 375 * struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp - EHT max supported NSS per MCS 376 * 377 * See P802.11be_D1.3 Table 9-401k - "Subfields of the Supported EHT-MCS 378 * and NSS Set field" 379 * 380 * @only_20mhz: MCS/NSS support for 20 MHz-only STA. 381 * @bw: MCS/NSS support for 80, 160 and 320 MHz 382 * @bw._80: MCS/NSS support for BW <= 80 MHz 383 * @bw._160: MCS/NSS support for BW = 160 MHz 384 * @bw._320: MCS/NSS support for BW = 320 MHz 385 */ 386 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp { 387 union { 388 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_20mhz_only only_20mhz; 389 struct { 390 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _80; 391 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _160; 392 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp_bw _320; 393 } __packed bw; 394 } __packed; 395 } __packed; 396 397 #define IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN 32 398 399 /** 400 * struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap - STA's EHT capabilities 401 * 402 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 403 * to describe 802.11be EHT capabilities for a STA. 404 * 405 * @has_eht: true iff EHT data is valid. 406 * @eht_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the eht capabilities element. 407 * @eht_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations. 408 * @eht_ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data. 409 */ 410 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap { 411 bool has_eht; 412 struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem_fixed eht_cap_elem; 413 struct ieee80211_eht_mcs_nss_supp eht_mcs_nss_supp; 414 u8 eht_ppe_thres[IEEE80211_EHT_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN]; 415 }; 416 417 /* sparse defines __CHECKER__; see Documentation/dev-tools/sparse.rst */ 418 #ifdef __CHECKER__ 419 /* 420 * This is used to mark the sband->iftype_data pointer which is supposed 421 * to be an array with special access semantics (per iftype), but a lot 422 * of code got it wrong in the past, so with this marking sparse will be 423 * noisy when the pointer is used directly. 424 */ 425 # define __iftd __attribute__((noderef, address_space(__iftype_data))) 426 #else 427 # define __iftd 428 #endif /* __CHECKER__ */ 429 430 /** 431 * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type 432 * 433 * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the 434 * interface types defined in @types_mask. Each type in the 435 * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data. 436 * 437 * @types_mask: interface types mask 438 * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities 439 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a 440 * 6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value). 441 * @eht_cap: STA's EHT capabilities 442 * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise 443 * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data 444 * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length 445 */ 446 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data { 447 u16 types_mask; 448 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap; 449 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa; 450 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap; 451 struct { 452 const u8 *data; 453 unsigned int len; 454 } vendor_elems; 455 }; 456 457 /** 458 * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations 459 * 460 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz 461 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz 462 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz 463 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz 464 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 465 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 466 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 467 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and 468 * 2.16GHz+2.16GHz 469 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 470 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 471 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 472 * 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 473 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz 474 * and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 475 * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz, 476 * 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz 477 */ 478 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config { 479 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4 = 4, 480 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5 = 5, 481 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6 = 6, 482 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7 = 7, 483 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8 = 8, 484 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9 = 9, 485 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10 = 10, 486 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11 = 11, 487 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12 = 12, 488 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13 = 13, 489 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14 = 14, 490 IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15 = 15, 491 }; 492 493 /** 494 * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration 495 * 496 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 497 * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration 498 * 499 * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s) 500 * that are allowed to be used for transmissions. 501 * Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc. 502 * Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported. 503 * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes 504 * the allowed channel bandwidth configurations 505 */ 506 struct ieee80211_edmg { 507 u8 channels; 508 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config; 509 }; 510 511 /** 512 * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities 513 * 514 * This structure describes most essential parameters needed 515 * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA. 516 * 517 * @s1g: is STA an S1G STA 518 * @cap: S1G capabilities information 519 * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set 520 */ 521 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap { 522 bool s1g; 523 u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */ 524 u8 nss_mcs[5]; 525 }; 526 527 /** 528 * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition 529 * 530 * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy 531 * is able to operate in. 532 * 533 * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with 534 * in this band. 535 * @band: the band this structure represents 536 * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels 537 * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with 538 * in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported 539 * rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM. 540 * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates 541 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band 542 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band 543 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band 544 * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band 545 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course) 546 * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries 547 * @iftype_data: interface type data entries. Note that the bits in 548 * @types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only 549 * one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of 550 * iftype_data). 551 */ 552 struct ieee80211_supported_band { 553 struct ieee80211_channel *channels; 554 struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates; 555 enum nl80211_band band; 556 int n_channels; 557 int n_bitrates; 558 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap; 559 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap; 560 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap; 561 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap; 562 u16 n_iftype_data; 563 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data __iftd *iftype_data; 564 }; 565 566 /** 567 * _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array 568 * @sband: the sband to initialize 569 * @iftd: the iftype data array pointer 570 * @n_iftd: the length of the iftype data array 571 * 572 * Set the sband iftype data array; use this where the length cannot 573 * be derived from the ARRAY_SIZE() of the argument, but prefer 574 * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data() where it can be used. 575 */ 576 static inline void 577 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 578 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftd, 579 u16 n_iftd) 580 { 581 sband->iftype_data = (const void __iftd __force *)iftd; 582 sband->n_iftype_data = n_iftd; 583 } 584 585 /** 586 * ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data - set sband iftype data array 587 * @sband: the sband to initialize 588 * @iftd: the iftype data array 589 */ 590 #define ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd) \ 591 _ieee80211_set_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftd, ARRAY_SIZE(iftd)) 592 593 /** 594 * for_each_sband_iftype_data - iterate sband iftype data entries 595 * @sband: the sband whose iftype_data array to iterate 596 * @i: iterator counter 597 * @iftd: iftype data pointer to set 598 */ 599 #define for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, iftd) \ 600 for (i = 0, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i]; \ 601 i < (sband)->n_iftype_data; \ 602 i++, iftd = (const void __force *)&(sband)->iftype_data[i]) 603 604 /** 605 * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype 606 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 607 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 608 * 609 * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found 610 */ 611 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data * 612 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 613 u8 iftype) 614 { 615 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data; 616 int i; 617 618 if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX)) 619 return NULL; 620 621 if (iftype == NL80211_IFTYPE_AP_VLAN) 622 iftype = NL80211_IFTYPE_AP; 623 624 for_each_sband_iftype_data(sband, i, data) { 625 if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype)) 626 return data; 627 } 628 629 return NULL; 630 } 631 632 /** 633 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype 634 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 635 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 636 * 637 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found 638 */ 639 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap * 640 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 641 u8 iftype) 642 { 643 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 644 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 645 646 if (data && data->he_cap.has_he) 647 return &data->he_cap; 648 649 return NULL; 650 } 651 652 /** 653 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities 654 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on 655 * @iftype: the iftype to search for 656 * 657 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities 658 */ 659 static inline __le16 660 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 661 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 662 { 663 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 664 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 665 666 if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he)) 667 return 0; 668 669 return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa; 670 } 671 672 /** 673 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap - return ETH capabilities for an sband's iftype 674 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on 675 * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype 676 * 677 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or NULL is none found 678 */ 679 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap * 680 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 681 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 682 { 683 const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data = 684 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype); 685 686 if (data && data->eht_cap.has_eht) 687 return &data->eht_cap; 688 689 return NULL; 690 } 691 692 /** 693 * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree 694 * 695 * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for 696 * 697 * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful 698 * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board 699 * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier). 700 * 701 * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable 702 * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with 703 * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make 704 * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified 705 * without affecting other devices. 706 * 707 * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev. 708 * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first. 709 * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register(). 710 */ 711 #ifdef CONFIG_OF 712 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy); 713 #else /* CONFIG_OF */ 714 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy) 715 { 716 } 717 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */ 718 719 720 /* 721 * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods 722 */ 723 724 /** 725 * DOC: Actions and configuration 726 * 727 * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration 728 * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these 729 * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these 730 * operations use are described separately. 731 * 732 * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status 733 * information via some functions that drivers need to call. 734 * 735 * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described 736 * in a separate chapter. 737 */ 738 739 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\ 740 WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN) 741 742 /** 743 * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters 744 * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise 745 * %MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set 746 * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames 747 * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface. 748 * If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may 749 * determine the address as needed. 750 * This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the 751 * %NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag. Others may support creating 752 ** only p2p devices with specified MAC. 753 * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets 754 * belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed 755 * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring 756 * MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed 757 */ 758 struct vif_params { 759 u32 flags; 760 int use_4addr; 761 u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN]; 762 const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups; 763 const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr; 764 }; 765 766 /** 767 * struct key_params - key information 768 * 769 * Information about a key 770 * 771 * @key: key material 772 * @key_len: length of key material 773 * @cipher: cipher suite selector 774 * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used 775 * with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian, 776 * length given by @seq_len. 777 * @seq_len: length of @seq. 778 * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero) 779 * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX) 780 */ 781 struct key_params { 782 const u8 *key; 783 const u8 *seq; 784 int key_len; 785 int seq_len; 786 u16 vlan_id; 787 u32 cipher; 788 enum nl80211_key_mode mode; 789 }; 790 791 /** 792 * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition 793 * @chan: the (control) channel 794 * @width: channel width 795 * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment 796 * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment 797 * (only with 80+80 MHz) 798 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration. 799 * If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero), 800 * chan will define the primary channel and all other 801 * parameters are ignored. 802 * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz 803 */ 804 struct cfg80211_chan_def { 805 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 806 enum nl80211_chan_width width; 807 u32 center_freq1; 808 u32 center_freq2; 809 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 810 u16 freq1_offset; 811 }; 812 813 /* 814 * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control 815 */ 816 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask { 817 struct { 818 u32 legacy; 819 u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN]; 820 u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX]; 821 u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX]; 822 enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi; 823 enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi; 824 enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf; 825 } control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 826 }; 827 828 829 /** 830 * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration 831 * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration 832 * of the peer. 833 * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify 834 * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed, 835 * similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp. 836 * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID 837 * @retry_long: retry count value 838 * @retry_short: retry count value 839 * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation 840 * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS 841 * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation 842 * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type 843 * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID 844 */ 845 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg { 846 bool config_override; 847 u8 tids; 848 u64 mask; 849 enum nl80211_tid_config noack; 850 u8 retry_long, retry_short; 851 enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu; 852 enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts; 853 enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu; 854 enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type; 855 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask; 856 }; 857 858 /** 859 * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration 860 * @peer: Station's MAC address 861 * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied 862 * @tid_conf: Configuration change info 863 */ 864 struct cfg80211_tid_config { 865 const u8 *peer; 866 u32 n_tid_conf; 867 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[] __counted_by(n_tid_conf); 868 }; 869 870 /** 871 * struct cfg80211_fils_aad - FILS AAD data 872 * @macaddr: STA MAC address 873 * @kek: FILS KEK 874 * @kek_len: FILS KEK length 875 * @snonce: STA Nonce 876 * @anonce: AP Nonce 877 */ 878 struct cfg80211_fils_aad { 879 const u8 *macaddr; 880 const u8 *kek; 881 u8 kek_len; 882 const u8 *snonce; 883 const u8 *anonce; 884 }; 885 886 /** 887 * struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp - enable/disable HW timestamping 888 * @macaddr: peer MAC address. NULL to enable/disable HW timestamping for all 889 * addresses. 890 * @enable: if set, enable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address. 891 * Otherwise disable HW timestamping for the specified MAC address. 892 */ 893 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp { 894 const u8 *macaddr; 895 bool enable; 896 }; 897 898 /** 899 * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef 900 * @chandef: the channel definition 901 * 902 * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given 903 * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion. 904 */ 905 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type 906 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 907 { 908 switch (chandef->width) { 909 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT: 910 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 911 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20: 912 return NL80211_CHAN_HT20; 913 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40: 914 if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq) 915 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS; 916 return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS; 917 default: 918 WARN_ON(1); 919 return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT; 920 } 921 } 922 923 /** 924 * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type 925 * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill 926 * @channel: the control channel 927 * @chantype: the channel type 928 * 929 * Given a channel type, create a channel definition. 930 */ 931 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 932 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 933 enum nl80211_channel_type chantype); 934 935 /** 936 * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical 937 * @chandef1: first channel definition 938 * @chandef2: second channel definition 939 * 940 * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are 941 * identical, %false otherwise. 942 */ 943 static inline bool 944 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 945 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2) 946 { 947 return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan && 948 chandef1->width == chandef2->width && 949 chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 && 950 chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset && 951 chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2); 952 } 953 954 /** 955 * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel 956 * 957 * @chandef: the channel definition 958 * 959 * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise. 960 */ 961 static inline bool 962 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 963 { 964 return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config; 965 } 966 967 /** 968 * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible 969 * @chandef1: first channel definition 970 * @chandef2: second channel definition 971 * 972 * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible, 973 * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise. 974 */ 975 const struct cfg80211_chan_def * 976 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1, 977 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2); 978 979 /** 980 * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid 981 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 982 * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise. 983 */ 984 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 985 986 /** 987 * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used 988 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 989 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 990 * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set 991 * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise. 992 */ 993 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy, 994 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 995 u32 prohibited_flags); 996 997 /** 998 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required 999 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 1000 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 1001 * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype 1002 * Returns: 1003 * 1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error 1004 */ 1005 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1006 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 1007 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 1008 1009 /** 1010 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable - checks if chandef is DFS usable and we 1011 * can/need start CAC on such channel 1012 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 1013 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 1014 * 1015 * Return: true if all channels available and at least 1016 * one channel requires CAC (NL80211_DFS_USABLE) 1017 */ 1018 bool cfg80211_chandef_dfs_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1019 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 1020 1021 /** 1022 * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time - get the DFS CAC time (in ms) for given 1023 * channel definition 1024 * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against 1025 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 1026 * 1027 * Returns: DFS CAC time (in ms) which applies for this channel definition 1028 */ 1029 unsigned int 1030 cfg80211_chandef_dfs_cac_time(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1031 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 1032 1033 /** 1034 * nl80211_send_chandef - sends the channel definition. 1035 * @msg: the msg to send channel definition 1036 * @chandef: the channel definition to check 1037 * 1038 * Returns: 0 if sent the channel definition to msg, < 0 on error 1039 **/ 1040 int nl80211_send_chandef(struct sk_buff *msg, const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 1041 1042 /** 1043 * ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags - return rate flags for channel width 1044 * @width: the channel width of the channel 1045 * 1046 * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK 1047 * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels. 1048 * 1049 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel width 1050 */ 1051 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags 1052 ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(enum nl80211_chan_width width) 1053 { 1054 switch (width) { 1055 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 1056 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ; 1057 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 1058 return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ; 1059 default: 1060 break; 1061 } 1062 return 0; 1063 } 1064 1065 /** 1066 * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel 1067 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 1068 * 1069 * See ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(). 1070 * 1071 * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel 1072 */ 1073 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags 1074 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 1075 { 1076 return ieee80211_chanwidth_rate_flags(chandef->width); 1077 } 1078 1079 /** 1080 * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef 1081 * 1082 * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel 1083 * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual 1084 * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels. 1085 * 1086 * @chandef: channel definition for the channel 1087 * 1088 * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef 1089 */ 1090 static inline int 1091 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 1092 { 1093 switch (chandef->width) { 1094 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5: 1095 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6, 1096 chandef->chan->max_power); 1097 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10: 1098 return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3, 1099 chandef->chan->max_power); 1100 default: 1101 break; 1102 } 1103 return chandef->chan->max_power; 1104 } 1105 1106 /** 1107 * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels 1108 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for 1109 * @band_mask: which bands to check on 1110 * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable, 1111 * %IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account 1112 */ 1113 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1114 unsigned long band_mask, 1115 u32 prohibited_flags); 1116 1117 /** 1118 * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags 1119 * 1120 * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in 1121 * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used 1122 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in 1123 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in 1124 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in 1125 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in 1126 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in 1127 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in 1128 * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in 1129 * 1130 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info 1131 * it has filled in during the get_survey(). 1132 */ 1133 enum survey_info_flags { 1134 SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM = BIT(0), 1135 SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE = BIT(1), 1136 SURVEY_INFO_TIME = BIT(2), 1137 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY = BIT(3), 1138 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY = BIT(4), 1139 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX = BIT(5), 1140 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX = BIT(6), 1141 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN = BIT(7), 1142 SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX = BIT(8), 1143 }; 1144 1145 /** 1146 * struct survey_info - channel survey response 1147 * 1148 * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single 1149 * record to report global statistics 1150 * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags 1151 * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are 1152 * optional 1153 * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel) 1154 * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy 1155 * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy 1156 * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data 1157 * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data 1158 * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning 1159 * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS 1160 * 1161 * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information. 1162 * 1163 * This structure can later be expanded with things like 1164 * channel duty cycle etc. 1165 */ 1166 struct survey_info { 1167 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 1168 u64 time; 1169 u64 time_busy; 1170 u64 time_ext_busy; 1171 u64 time_rx; 1172 u64 time_tx; 1173 u64 time_scan; 1174 u64 time_bss_rx; 1175 u32 filled; 1176 s8 noise; 1177 }; 1178 1179 #define CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES 10 1180 1181 /** 1182 * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings 1183 * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled 1184 * (from enum nl80211_wpa_versions) 1185 * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset) 1186 * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers 1187 * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites 1188 * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites 1189 * @akm_suites: AKM suites 1190 * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 1191 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 1192 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 1193 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 1194 * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be 1195 * allowed through even on unauthorized ports 1196 * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port 1197 * protocol frames. 1198 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 1199 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 1200 * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control 1201 * port for mac80211 1202 * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload) 1203 * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE 1204 * offload) 1205 * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload) 1206 * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation: 1207 * 1208 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED 1209 * Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any 1210 * preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in 1211 * such a scenario. 1212 * 1213 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK 1214 * Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only 1215 * 1216 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT 1217 * Allow hash-to-element only 1218 * 1219 * NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH 1220 * Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element 1221 */ 1222 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings { 1223 u32 wpa_versions; 1224 u32 cipher_group; 1225 int n_ciphers_pairwise; 1226 u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES]; 1227 int n_akm_suites; 1228 u32 akm_suites[CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES]; 1229 bool control_port; 1230 __be16 control_port_ethertype; 1231 bool control_port_no_encrypt; 1232 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 1233 bool control_port_no_preauth; 1234 const u8 *psk; 1235 const u8 *sae_pwd; 1236 u8 sae_pwd_len; 1237 enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe; 1238 }; 1239 1240 /** 1241 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_config - AP settings for multi bssid 1242 * 1243 * @tx_wdev: pointer to the transmitted interface in the MBSSID set 1244 * @index: index of this AP in the multi bssid group. 1245 * @ema: set to true if the beacons should be sent out in EMA mode. 1246 */ 1247 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config { 1248 struct wireless_dev *tx_wdev; 1249 u8 index; 1250 bool ema; 1251 }; 1252 1253 /** 1254 * struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems - Multiple BSSID elements 1255 * 1256 * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems. 1257 * 1258 * @elem: Array of multiple BSSID element(s) to be added into Beacon frames. 1259 * @elem.data: Data for multiple BSSID elements. 1260 * @elem.len: Length of data. 1261 */ 1262 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems { 1263 u8 cnt; 1264 struct { 1265 const u8 *data; 1266 size_t len; 1267 } elem[] __counted_by(cnt); 1268 }; 1269 1270 /** 1271 * struct cfg80211_rnr_elems - Reduced neighbor report (RNR) elements 1272 * 1273 * @cnt: Number of elements in array %elems. 1274 * 1275 * @elem: Array of RNR element(s) to be added into Beacon frames. 1276 * @elem.data: Data for RNR elements. 1277 * @elem.len: Length of data. 1278 */ 1279 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems { 1280 u8 cnt; 1281 struct { 1282 const u8 *data; 1283 size_t len; 1284 } elem[] __counted_by(cnt); 1285 }; 1286 1287 /** 1288 * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data 1289 * @link_id: the link ID for the AP MLD link sending this beacon 1290 * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE) 1291 * or %NULL if not changed 1292 * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE) 1293 * or %NULL if not changed 1294 * @head_len: length of @head 1295 * @tail_len: length of @tail 1296 * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL 1297 * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets 1298 * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response 1299 * frames or %NULL 1300 * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets 1301 * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association 1302 * Response frames or %NULL 1303 * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets 1304 * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp) 1305 * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only) 1306 * @mbssid_ies: multiple BSSID elements 1307 * @rnr_ies: reduced neighbor report elements 1308 * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change 1309 * (which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data) 1310 * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token 1311 * (measurement type 8) 1312 * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement 1313 * Token (measurement type 11) 1314 * @lci_len: LCI data length 1315 * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length 1316 * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings 1317 * @he_bss_color_valid: indicates whether bss color 1318 * attribute is present in beacon data or not. 1319 */ 1320 struct cfg80211_beacon_data { 1321 unsigned int link_id; 1322 1323 const u8 *head, *tail; 1324 const u8 *beacon_ies; 1325 const u8 *proberesp_ies; 1326 const u8 *assocresp_ies; 1327 const u8 *probe_resp; 1328 const u8 *lci; 1329 const u8 *civicloc; 1330 struct cfg80211_mbssid_elems *mbssid_ies; 1331 struct cfg80211_rnr_elems *rnr_ies; 1332 s8 ftm_responder; 1333 1334 size_t head_len, tail_len; 1335 size_t beacon_ies_len; 1336 size_t proberesp_ies_len; 1337 size_t assocresp_ies_len; 1338 size_t probe_resp_len; 1339 size_t lci_len; 1340 size_t civicloc_len; 1341 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color; 1342 bool he_bss_color_valid; 1343 }; 1344 1345 struct mac_address { 1346 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 1347 }; 1348 1349 /** 1350 * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data 1351 * 1352 * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's 1353 * entry specified by mac_addr 1354 * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed 1355 * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL 1356 */ 1357 struct cfg80211_acl_data { 1358 enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy; 1359 int n_acl_entries; 1360 1361 /* Keep it last */ 1362 struct mac_address mac_addrs[] __counted_by(n_acl_entries); 1363 }; 1364 1365 /** 1366 * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from 1367 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail. 1368 * 1369 * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated. 1370 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1371 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000) 1372 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1373 * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action 1374 * frame headers. 1375 */ 1376 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery { 1377 bool update; 1378 u32 min_interval; 1379 u32 max_interval; 1380 size_t tmpl_len; 1381 const u8 *tmpl; 1382 }; 1383 1384 /** 1385 * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe 1386 * response parameters in 6GHz. 1387 * 1388 * @update: Set to true if the feature configuration should be updated. 1389 * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned 1390 * in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive 1391 * scanning 1392 * @tmpl_len: Template length 1393 * @tmpl: Template data for probe response 1394 */ 1395 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp { 1396 bool update; 1397 u32 interval; 1398 size_t tmpl_len; 1399 const u8 *tmpl; 1400 }; 1401 1402 /** 1403 * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration 1404 * 1405 * Used to configure an AP interface. 1406 * 1407 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 1408 * @beacon: beacon data 1409 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1410 * @dtim_period: DTIM period 1411 * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from 1412 * user space) 1413 * @ssid_len: length of @ssid 1414 * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames 1415 * @crypto: crypto settings 1416 * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy 1417 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 1418 * @smps_mode: SMPS mode 1419 * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity. 1420 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window 1421 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS 1422 * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for 1423 * MAC address based access control 1424 * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG 1425 * networks. 1426 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 1427 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled) 1428 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled) 1429 * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1430 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled) 1431 * @eht_oper: EHT operation IE (or %NULL if EHT isn't enabled) 1432 * @ht_required: stations must support HT 1433 * @vht_required: stations must support VHT 1434 * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time 1435 * @he_required: stations must support HE 1436 * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE 1437 * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_ap_settings_flags 1438 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings 1439 * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled) 1440 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters 1441 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters 1442 * @mbssid_config: AP settings for multiple bssid 1443 * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents 1444 * a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel. 1445 * Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured. 1446 */ 1447 struct cfg80211_ap_settings { 1448 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1449 1450 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon; 1451 1452 int beacon_interval, dtim_period; 1453 const u8 *ssid; 1454 size_t ssid_len; 1455 enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid; 1456 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 1457 bool privacy; 1458 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 1459 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 1460 int inactivity_timeout; 1461 u8 p2p_ctwindow; 1462 bool p2p_opp_ps; 1463 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl; 1464 bool pbss; 1465 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 1466 1467 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap; 1468 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap; 1469 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap; 1470 const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper; 1471 const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_cap; 1472 const struct ieee80211_eht_operation *eht_oper; 1473 bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required; 1474 bool twt_responder; 1475 u32 flags; 1476 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd; 1477 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 1478 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp; 1479 struct cfg80211_mbssid_config mbssid_config; 1480 u16 punct_bitmap; 1481 }; 1482 1483 1484 /** 1485 * struct cfg80211_ap_update - AP configuration update 1486 * 1487 * Subset of &struct cfg80211_ap_settings, for updating a running AP. 1488 * 1489 * @beacon: beacon data 1490 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters 1491 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters 1492 */ 1493 struct cfg80211_ap_update { 1494 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon; 1495 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery; 1496 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp; 1497 }; 1498 1499 /** 1500 * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings 1501 * 1502 * Used for channel switch 1503 * 1504 * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch 1505 * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch 1506 * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) 1507 * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response 1508 * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail) 1509 * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response 1510 * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel 1511 * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel 1512 * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing 1513 * @count: number of beacons until switch 1514 * @punct_bitmap: Preamble puncturing bitmap. Each bit represents 1515 * a 20 MHz channel, lowest bit corresponding to the lowest channel. 1516 * Bit set to 1 indicates that the channel is punctured. 1517 */ 1518 struct cfg80211_csa_settings { 1519 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 1520 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa; 1521 const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon; 1522 const u16 *counter_offsets_presp; 1523 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon; 1524 unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp; 1525 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after; 1526 bool radar_required; 1527 bool block_tx; 1528 u8 count; 1529 u16 punct_bitmap; 1530 }; 1531 1532 /** 1533 * struct cfg80211_color_change_settings - color change settings 1534 * 1535 * Used for bss color change 1536 * 1537 * @beacon_color_change: beacon data while performing the color countdown 1538 * @counter_offset_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail) 1539 * @counter_offset_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response 1540 * @beacon_next: beacon data to be used after the color change 1541 * @count: number of beacons until the color change 1542 * @color: the color used after the change 1543 */ 1544 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings { 1545 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_color_change; 1546 u16 counter_offset_beacon; 1547 u16 counter_offset_presp; 1548 struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_next; 1549 u8 count; 1550 u8 color; 1551 }; 1552 1553 /** 1554 * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations 1555 * 1556 * Used to pass interface combination parameters 1557 * 1558 * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want 1559 * to use for verification 1560 * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel 1561 * width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of 1562 * &struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths 1563 * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface 1564 * type. The index is the interface type as specified in &enum 1565 * nl80211_iftype. 1566 * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface 1567 * that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of 1568 * the verification 1569 */ 1570 struct iface_combination_params { 1571 int num_different_channels; 1572 u8 radar_detect; 1573 int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES]; 1574 u32 new_beacon_int; 1575 }; 1576 1577 /** 1578 * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply 1579 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp) 1580 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability 1581 * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state 1582 * 1583 * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling, 1584 * for those that don't these flags will are used. 1585 */ 1586 enum station_parameters_apply_mask { 1587 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0), 1588 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1), 1589 STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2), 1590 }; 1591 1592 /** 1593 * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration 1594 * 1595 * Used to configure txpower for station. 1596 * 1597 * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power 1598 * is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be 1599 * overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx 1600 * power per-interface or per-station. 1601 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power 1602 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC 1603 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power. 1604 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for 1605 * per peer TPC. 1606 */ 1607 struct sta_txpwr { 1608 s16 power; 1609 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type; 1610 }; 1611 1612 /** 1613 * struct link_station_parameters - link station parameters 1614 * 1615 * Used to change and create a new link station. 1616 * 1617 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station 1618 * @link_id: the link id (-1 for non-MLD station) 1619 * @link_mac: MAC address of the link 1620 * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format 1621 * (or NULL for no change) 1622 * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates 1623 * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station 1624 * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station 1625 * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification 1626 * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used 1627 * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station 1628 * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities 1629 * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station 1630 * @txpwr_set: txpwr field is set 1631 * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station 1632 * @eht_capa: EHT capabilities of station 1633 * @eht_capa_len: the length of the EHT capabilities 1634 */ 1635 struct link_station_parameters { 1636 const u8 *mld_mac; 1637 int link_id; 1638 const u8 *link_mac; 1639 const u8 *supported_rates; 1640 u8 supported_rates_len; 1641 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa; 1642 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa; 1643 u8 opmode_notif; 1644 bool opmode_notif_used; 1645 const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa; 1646 u8 he_capa_len; 1647 struct sta_txpwr txpwr; 1648 bool txpwr_set; 1649 const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa; 1650 const struct ieee80211_eht_cap_elem *eht_capa; 1651 u8 eht_capa_len; 1652 }; 1653 1654 /** 1655 * struct link_station_del_parameters - link station deletion parameters 1656 * 1657 * Used to delete a link station entry (or all stations). 1658 * 1659 * @mld_mac: MAC address of the station 1660 * @link_id: the link id 1661 */ 1662 struct link_station_del_parameters { 1663 const u8 *mld_mac; 1664 u32 link_id; 1665 }; 1666 1667 /** 1668 * struct station_parameters - station parameters 1669 * 1670 * Used to change and create a new station. 1671 * 1672 * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to 1673 * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed 1674 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1675 * @sta_flags_set: station flags values 1676 * (bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...)) 1677 * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change 1678 * @aid: AID or zero for no change 1679 * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero) 1680 * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change 1681 * @plink_action: plink action to take 1682 * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station 1683 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format 1684 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 1685 * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the 1686 * QoS info field (but already shifted down) 1687 * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed 1688 * (for those that don't have a natural "no change" value), 1689 * see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask 1690 * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set 1691 * to unknown) 1692 * @capability: station capability 1693 * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station 1694 * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities 1695 * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format 1696 * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels 1697 * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format 1698 * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes 1699 * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism 1700 * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station 1701 * @link_sta_params: link related params. 1702 */ 1703 struct station_parameters { 1704 struct net_device *vlan; 1705 u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set; 1706 u32 sta_modify_mask; 1707 int listen_interval; 1708 u16 aid; 1709 u16 vlan_id; 1710 u16 peer_aid; 1711 u8 plink_action; 1712 u8 plink_state; 1713 u8 uapsd_queues; 1714 u8 max_sp; 1715 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 1716 u16 capability; 1717 const u8 *ext_capab; 1718 u8 ext_capab_len; 1719 const u8 *supported_channels; 1720 u8 supported_channels_len; 1721 const u8 *supported_oper_classes; 1722 u8 supported_oper_classes_len; 1723 int support_p2p_ps; 1724 u16 airtime_weight; 1725 struct link_station_parameters link_sta_params; 1726 }; 1727 1728 /** 1729 * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters 1730 * 1731 * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations). 1732 * 1733 * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations 1734 * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal 1735 * (10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication) 1736 * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame 1737 */ 1738 struct station_del_parameters { 1739 const u8 *mac; 1740 u8 subtype; 1741 u16 reason_code; 1742 }; 1743 1744 /** 1745 * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified 1746 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface 1747 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still 1748 * unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted) 1749 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has 1750 * the AP MLME in the device 1751 * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface 1752 * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station 1753 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry 1754 * while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when 1755 * being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is 1756 * supported/used) 1757 * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active 1758 * entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace) 1759 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed) 1760 * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed) 1761 */ 1762 enum cfg80211_station_type { 1763 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT, 1764 CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC, 1765 CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT, 1766 CFG80211_STA_AP_STA, 1767 CFG80211_STA_IBSS, 1768 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP, 1769 CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE, 1770 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL, 1771 CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER, 1772 }; 1773 1774 /** 1775 * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes 1776 * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on 1777 * @params: the new parameters for a station 1778 * @statype: the type of station being modified 1779 * 1780 * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function 1781 * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that 1782 * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if 1783 * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for 1784 * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this. 1785 */ 1786 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy, 1787 struct station_parameters *params, 1788 enum cfg80211_station_type statype); 1789 1790 /** 1791 * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags 1792 * 1793 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1794 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1795 * 1796 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS 1797 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS 1798 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval 1799 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS 1800 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information 1801 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode 1802 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS 1803 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS: EHT MCS information 1804 * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS: MCS field filled with S1G MCS 1805 */ 1806 enum rate_info_flags { 1807 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS = BIT(0), 1808 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS = BIT(1), 1809 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI = BIT(2), 1810 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG = BIT(3), 1811 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS = BIT(4), 1812 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG = BIT(5), 1813 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG = BIT(6), 1814 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EHT_MCS = BIT(7), 1815 RATE_INFO_FLAGS_S1G_MCS = BIT(8), 1816 }; 1817 1818 /** 1819 * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information 1820 * 1821 * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth. 1822 * 1823 * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth 1824 * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth 1825 * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth 1826 * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth 1827 * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth 1828 * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth 1829 * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation 1830 * @RATE_INFO_BW_320: 320 MHz bandwidth 1831 * @RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU: bandwidth determined by EHT RU allocation 1832 * @RATE_INFO_BW_1: 1 MHz bandwidth 1833 * @RATE_INFO_BW_2: 2 MHz bandwidth 1834 * @RATE_INFO_BW_4: 4 MHz bandwidth 1835 * @RATE_INFO_BW_8: 8 MHz bandwidth 1836 * @RATE_INFO_BW_16: 16 MHz bandwidth 1837 */ 1838 enum rate_info_bw { 1839 RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0, 1840 RATE_INFO_BW_5, 1841 RATE_INFO_BW_10, 1842 RATE_INFO_BW_40, 1843 RATE_INFO_BW_80, 1844 RATE_INFO_BW_160, 1845 RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU, 1846 RATE_INFO_BW_320, 1847 RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU, 1848 RATE_INFO_BW_1, 1849 RATE_INFO_BW_2, 1850 RATE_INFO_BW_4, 1851 RATE_INFO_BW_8, 1852 RATE_INFO_BW_16, 1853 }; 1854 1855 /** 1856 * struct rate_info - bitrate information 1857 * 1858 * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate 1859 * 1860 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags 1861 * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg 1862 * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE/EHT/S1G rate 1863 * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only) 1864 * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw) 1865 * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi) 1866 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value 1867 * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc, 1868 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU) 1869 * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4) 1870 * @eht_gi: EHT guard interval (from &enum nl80211_eht_gi) 1871 * @eht_ru_alloc: EHT RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc, 1872 * only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_EHT_RU) 1873 */ 1874 struct rate_info { 1875 u16 flags; 1876 u16 legacy; 1877 u8 mcs; 1878 u8 nss; 1879 u8 bw; 1880 u8 he_gi; 1881 u8 he_dcm; 1882 u8 he_ru_alloc; 1883 u8 n_bonded_ch; 1884 u8 eht_gi; 1885 u8 eht_ru_alloc; 1886 }; 1887 1888 /** 1889 * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags 1890 * 1891 * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission 1892 * type for 802.11n transmissions. 1893 * 1894 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled 1895 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled 1896 * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled 1897 */ 1898 enum bss_param_flags { 1899 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT = 1<<0, 1900 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE = 1<<1, 1901 BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME = 1<<2, 1902 }; 1903 1904 /** 1905 * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station 1906 * 1907 * Information about the currently associated BSS 1908 * 1909 * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags 1910 * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS 1911 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval 1912 */ 1913 struct sta_bss_parameters { 1914 u8 flags; 1915 u8 dtim_period; 1916 u16 beacon_interval; 1917 }; 1918 1919 /** 1920 * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID 1921 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to 1922 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1923 * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged 1924 * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged 1925 * @flows: number of new flows seen 1926 * @drops: total number of packets dropped 1927 * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE 1928 * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow 1929 * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow 1930 * @collisions: number of hash collisions 1931 * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued 1932 * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued 1933 * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported 1934 */ 1935 struct cfg80211_txq_stats { 1936 u32 filled; 1937 u32 backlog_bytes; 1938 u32 backlog_packets; 1939 u32 flows; 1940 u32 drops; 1941 u32 ecn_marks; 1942 u32 overlimit; 1943 u32 overmemory; 1944 u32 collisions; 1945 u32 tx_bytes; 1946 u32 tx_packets; 1947 u32 max_flows; 1948 }; 1949 1950 /** 1951 * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics 1952 * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to 1953 * indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled 1954 * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs 1955 * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs 1956 * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for 1957 * transmitted MSDUs 1958 * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs 1959 * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics 1960 */ 1961 struct cfg80211_tid_stats { 1962 u32 filled; 1963 u64 rx_msdu; 1964 u64 tx_msdu; 1965 u64 tx_msdu_retries; 1966 u64 tx_msdu_failed; 1967 struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats; 1968 }; 1969 1970 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS 4 1971 1972 /** 1973 * struct station_info - station information 1974 * 1975 * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station. 1976 * 1977 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to 1978 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 1979 * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected 1980 * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds 1981 * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association 1982 * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station 1983 * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station 1984 * @llid: mesh local link id 1985 * @plid: mesh peer link id 1986 * @plink_state: mesh peer link state 1987 * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1988 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1989 * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type. 1990 * For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_. 1991 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg 1992 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm 1993 * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm 1994 * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station 1995 * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station 1996 * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station 1997 * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station 1998 * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs) 1999 * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK) 2000 * @rx_dropped_misc: Dropped for un-specified reason. 2001 * @bss_param: current BSS parameters 2002 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 2003 * This number should increase every time the list of stations 2004 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 2005 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 2006 * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request. 2007 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use 2008 * user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for 2009 * the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. 2010 * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets. 2011 * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values 2012 * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered. 2013 * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host. 2014 * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode 2015 * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode 2016 * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode 2017 * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers) 2018 * towards this station. 2019 * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer 2020 * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received 2021 * from this peer 2022 * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate 2023 * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer 2024 * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer 2025 * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight 2026 * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last 2027 * (IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs. 2028 * Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL. 2029 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame. 2030 * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has 2031 * been sent. 2032 * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station 2033 * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with 2034 * an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the 2035 * received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address. 2036 * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric. 2037 * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server 2038 * @mlo_params_valid: Indicates @assoc_link_id and @mld_addr fields are filled 2039 * by driver. Drivers use this only in cfg80211_new_sta() calls when AP 2040 * MLD's MLME/SME is offload to driver. Drivers won't fill this 2041 * information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and 2042 * dump_station() callbacks. 2043 * @assoc_link_id: Indicates MLO link ID of the AP, with which the station 2044 * completed (re)association. This information filled for both MLO 2045 * and non-MLO STA connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. 2046 * @mld_addr: For MLO STA connection, filled with MLD address of the station. 2047 * For non-MLO STA connection, filled with all zeros. 2048 * @assoc_resp_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Response. 2049 * This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use user 2050 * space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided only for the 2051 * cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs. Drivers won't 2052 * fill this information in cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(), get_station() and 2053 * dump_station() callbacks. User space needs this information to determine 2054 * the accepted and rejected affiliated links of the connected station. 2055 * @assoc_resp_ies_len: Length of @assoc_resp_ies buffer in octets. 2056 */ 2057 struct station_info { 2058 u64 filled; 2059 u32 connected_time; 2060 u32 inactive_time; 2061 u64 assoc_at; 2062 u64 rx_bytes; 2063 u64 tx_bytes; 2064 u16 llid; 2065 u16 plid; 2066 u8 plink_state; 2067 s8 signal; 2068 s8 signal_avg; 2069 2070 u8 chains; 2071 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2072 s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2073 2074 struct rate_info txrate; 2075 struct rate_info rxrate; 2076 u32 rx_packets; 2077 u32 tx_packets; 2078 u32 tx_retries; 2079 u32 tx_failed; 2080 u32 rx_dropped_misc; 2081 struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param; 2082 struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags; 2083 2084 int generation; 2085 2086 const u8 *assoc_req_ies; 2087 size_t assoc_req_ies_len; 2088 2089 u32 beacon_loss_count; 2090 s64 t_offset; 2091 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm; 2092 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm; 2093 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm; 2094 2095 u32 expected_throughput; 2096 2097 u64 tx_duration; 2098 u64 rx_duration; 2099 u64 rx_beacon; 2100 u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg; 2101 u8 connected_to_gate; 2102 2103 struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid; 2104 s8 ack_signal; 2105 s8 avg_ack_signal; 2106 2107 u16 airtime_weight; 2108 2109 u32 rx_mpdu_count; 2110 u32 fcs_err_count; 2111 2112 u32 airtime_link_metric; 2113 2114 u8 connected_to_as; 2115 2116 bool mlo_params_valid; 2117 u8 assoc_link_id; 2118 u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2119 const u8 *assoc_resp_ies; 2120 size_t assoc_resp_ies_len; 2121 }; 2122 2123 /** 2124 * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit 2125 * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm 2126 * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to 2127 */ 2128 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs { 2129 s32 power; 2130 u32 freq_range_index; 2131 }; 2132 2133 /** 2134 * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs 2135 * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types 2136 * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs 2137 * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs 2138 */ 2139 struct cfg80211_sar_specs { 2140 enum nl80211_sar_type type; 2141 u32 num_sub_specs; 2142 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[]; 2143 }; 2144 2145 2146 /** 2147 * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges 2148 * @start_freq: start range edge frequency 2149 * @end_freq: end range edge frequency 2150 */ 2151 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges { 2152 u32 start_freq; 2153 u32 end_freq; 2154 }; 2155 2156 /** 2157 * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability 2158 * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types 2159 * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges 2160 * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges. 2161 * 2162 * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing 2163 * range to small ones and then append them. 2164 */ 2165 struct cfg80211_sar_capa { 2166 enum nl80211_sar_type type; 2167 u32 num_freq_ranges; 2168 const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges; 2169 }; 2170 2171 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) 2172 /** 2173 * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station 2174 * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to 2175 * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest 2176 * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information 2177 * 2178 * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information 2179 * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be 2180 * considered undefined. 2181 */ 2182 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 2183 struct station_info *sinfo); 2184 #else 2185 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, 2186 const u8 *mac_addr, 2187 struct station_info *sinfo) 2188 { 2189 return -ENOENT; 2190 } 2191 #endif 2192 2193 /** 2194 * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags 2195 * 2196 * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits 2197 * according to the nl80211 flags. 2198 * 2199 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed 2200 * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS 2201 * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP 2202 * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames 2203 * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering 2204 * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing 2205 * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address 2206 */ 2207 enum monitor_flags { 2208 MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED = 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID, 2209 MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL, 2210 MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL, 2211 MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL, 2212 MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS, 2213 MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES, 2214 MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE = 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE, 2215 }; 2216 2217 /** 2218 * enum mpath_info_flags - mesh path information flags 2219 * 2220 * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled 2221 * in during get_station() or dump_station(). 2222 * 2223 * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled 2224 * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled 2225 * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled 2226 * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled 2227 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled 2228 * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled 2229 * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled 2230 * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled 2231 * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled 2232 */ 2233 enum mpath_info_flags { 2234 MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN = BIT(0), 2235 MPATH_INFO_SN = BIT(1), 2236 MPATH_INFO_METRIC = BIT(2), 2237 MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME = BIT(3), 2238 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT = BIT(4), 2239 MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES = BIT(5), 2240 MPATH_INFO_FLAGS = BIT(6), 2241 MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT = BIT(7), 2242 MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE = BIT(8), 2243 }; 2244 2245 /** 2246 * struct mpath_info - mesh path information 2247 * 2248 * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath(). 2249 * 2250 * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags 2251 * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination 2252 * @sn: target sequence number 2253 * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path 2254 * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs 2255 * @flags: mesh path flags from &enum mesh_path_flags 2256 * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs 2257 * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries 2258 * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps. 2259 * This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths 2260 * changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that 2261 * userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot. 2262 * @hop_count: hops to destination 2263 * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination 2264 */ 2265 struct mpath_info { 2266 u32 filled; 2267 u32 frame_qlen; 2268 u32 sn; 2269 u32 metric; 2270 u32 exptime; 2271 u32 discovery_timeout; 2272 u8 discovery_retries; 2273 u8 flags; 2274 u8 hop_count; 2275 u32 path_change_count; 2276 2277 int generation; 2278 }; 2279 2280 /** 2281 * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters 2282 * 2283 * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode). 2284 * 2285 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD 2286 * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection 2287 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 2288 * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed 2289 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 2290 * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed 2291 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 2292 * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format 2293 * (or NULL for no change) 2294 * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates 2295 * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations 2296 * (0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change) 2297 * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode 2298 * (u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change) 2299 * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change) 2300 * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change) 2301 */ 2302 struct bss_parameters { 2303 int link_id; 2304 int use_cts_prot; 2305 int use_short_preamble; 2306 int use_short_slot_time; 2307 const u8 *basic_rates; 2308 u8 basic_rates_len; 2309 int ap_isolate; 2310 int ht_opmode; 2311 s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps; 2312 }; 2313 2314 /** 2315 * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration 2316 * 2317 * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active. 2318 * 2319 * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used 2320 * by the Mesh Peering Open message 2321 * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units 2322 * used by the Mesh Peering Open message 2323 * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by 2324 * the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering 2325 * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this 2326 * mesh interface 2327 * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can 2328 * be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh 2329 * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA 2330 * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection 2331 * elements 2332 * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we 2333 * detect compatible mesh peers 2334 * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to 2335 * synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method 2336 * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ 2337 * that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target 2338 * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds 2339 * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on 2340 * a path discovery in milliseconds 2341 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 2342 * receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the 2343 * root to be valid. (TU = time unit) 2344 * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 2345 * which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ 2346 * element 2347 * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during 2348 * which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR 2349 * element 2350 * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that 2351 * it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh 2352 * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA 2353 * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root 2354 * announcements are transmitted 2355 * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh 2356 * station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is 2357 * missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true 2358 * only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but 2359 * not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the 2360 * same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec) 2361 * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding 2362 * entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity) 2363 * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate 2364 * station to establish a peer link 2365 * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode 2366 * 2367 * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs 2368 * receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to 2369 * the root mesh STA to be valid. 2370 * 2371 * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive 2372 * PREQs are transmitted. 2373 * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs) 2374 * during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing 2375 * a PREQ element for root path confirmation. 2376 * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial 2377 * setting for new peer links. 2378 * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake 2379 * after transmitting its beacon. 2380 * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established 2381 * peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it 2382 * from the STA's list of peers. Default is 30 minutes. 2383 * @dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer: if set to true then this mesh STA 2384 * will advertise that it is connected to a authentication server 2385 * in the mesh formation field. 2386 * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is 2387 * connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info. If false, the 2388 * value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths 2389 * in the mesh path table 2390 * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP 2391 * for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might 2392 * not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So 2393 * if using this setting you will likely also want to disable 2394 * dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top. 2395 */ 2396 struct mesh_config { 2397 u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout; 2398 u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout; 2399 u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout; 2400 u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks; 2401 u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries; 2402 u8 dot11MeshTTL; 2403 u8 element_ttl; 2404 bool auto_open_plinks; 2405 u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor; 2406 u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries; 2407 u32 path_refresh_time; 2408 u16 min_discovery_timeout; 2409 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout; 2410 u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval; 2411 u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval; 2412 u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime; 2413 u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode; 2414 bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate; 2415 bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer; 2416 u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval; 2417 bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol; 2418 bool dot11MeshForwarding; 2419 s32 rssi_threshold; 2420 u16 ht_opmode; 2421 u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout; 2422 u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval; 2423 u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval; 2424 enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode; 2425 u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration; 2426 u32 plink_timeout; 2427 bool dot11MeshNolearn; 2428 }; 2429 2430 /** 2431 * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration 2432 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 2433 * @mesh_id: the mesh ID 2434 * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes 2435 * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use 2436 * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use 2437 * @path_metric: which metric to use 2438 * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using 2439 * @ie: vendor information elements (optional) 2440 * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements 2441 * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication 2442 * @is_secure: this mesh uses security 2443 * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions 2444 * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use 2445 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 2446 * @mcast_rate: multicast rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a] 2447 * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh 2448 * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons 2449 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 2450 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 2451 * to operate on DFS channels. 2452 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 2453 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 2454 * 2455 * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created. 2456 */ 2457 struct mesh_setup { 2458 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2459 const u8 *mesh_id; 2460 u8 mesh_id_len; 2461 u8 sync_method; 2462 u8 path_sel_proto; 2463 u8 path_metric; 2464 u8 auth_id; 2465 const u8 *ie; 2466 u8 ie_len; 2467 bool is_authenticated; 2468 bool is_secure; 2469 bool user_mpm; 2470 u8 dtim_period; 2471 u16 beacon_interval; 2472 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2473 u32 basic_rates; 2474 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate; 2475 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 2476 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 2477 }; 2478 2479 /** 2480 * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration 2481 * @chandef: defines the channel to use 2482 * 2483 * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network 2484 */ 2485 struct ocb_setup { 2486 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 2487 }; 2488 2489 /** 2490 * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters 2491 * @ac: AC identifier 2492 * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled 2493 * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2494 * 1..32767] 2495 * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range 2496 * 1..32767] 2497 * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255] 2498 * @link_id: link_id or -1 for non-MLD 2499 */ 2500 struct ieee80211_txq_params { 2501 enum nl80211_ac ac; 2502 u16 txop; 2503 u16 cwmin; 2504 u16 cwmax; 2505 u8 aifs; 2506 int link_id; 2507 }; 2508 2509 /** 2510 * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling 2511 * 2512 * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite 2513 * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will 2514 * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the 2515 * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the 2516 * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to 2517 * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements 2518 * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be 2519 * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised 2520 * in the wiphy structure. 2521 * 2522 * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because 2523 * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not 2524 * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist. 2525 * 2526 * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of 2527 * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the 2528 * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available 2529 * to userspace. 2530 */ 2531 2532 /** 2533 * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description 2534 * @ssid: the SSID 2535 * @ssid_len: length of the ssid 2536 */ 2537 struct cfg80211_ssid { 2538 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 2539 u8 ssid_len; 2540 }; 2541 2542 /** 2543 * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan 2544 * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the 2545 * wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this 2546 * information is not available, this field is left zero. 2547 * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set. 2548 * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason, 2549 * userspace will be notified of that 2550 */ 2551 struct cfg80211_scan_info { 2552 u64 scan_start_tsf; 2553 u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2554 bool aborted; 2555 }; 2556 2557 /** 2558 * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only 2559 * 2560 * @short_ssid: short ssid to scan for 2561 * @bssid: bssid to scan for 2562 * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request 2563 * which the above info relvant to 2564 * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU 2565 * @short_ssid_valid: @short_ssid is valid and can be used 2566 * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait 2567 * 20 TUs before starting to send probe requests. 2568 * @psd_20: The AP's 20 MHz PSD value. 2569 */ 2570 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params { 2571 u32 short_ssid; 2572 u32 channel_idx; 2573 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2574 bool unsolicited_probe; 2575 bool short_ssid_valid; 2576 bool psc_no_listen; 2577 s8 psd_20; 2578 }; 2579 2580 /** 2581 * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description 2582 * 2583 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only) 2584 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2585 * @channels: channels to scan on. 2586 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2587 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2588 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2589 * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If 2590 * %duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and 2591 * the actual dwell time may be shorter. 2592 * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the 2593 * %duration field. 2594 * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags 2595 * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band 2596 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2597 * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started 2598 * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for 2599 * @info: (internal) information about completed scan 2600 * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted 2601 * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band 2602 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2603 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2604 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2605 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2606 * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only, 2607 * true if this is the second scan request 2608 * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params 2609 * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params 2610 * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID) 2611 */ 2612 struct cfg80211_scan_request { 2613 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2614 int n_ssids; 2615 u32 n_channels; 2616 const u8 *ie; 2617 size_t ie_len; 2618 u16 duration; 2619 bool duration_mandatory; 2620 u32 flags; 2621 2622 u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2623 2624 struct wireless_dev *wdev; 2625 2626 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2627 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2628 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2629 2630 /* internal */ 2631 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2632 unsigned long scan_start; 2633 struct cfg80211_scan_info info; 2634 bool notified; 2635 bool no_cck; 2636 bool scan_6ghz; 2637 u32 n_6ghz_params; 2638 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params; 2639 2640 /* keep last */ 2641 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[] __counted_by(n_channels); 2642 }; 2643 2644 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask) 2645 { 2646 int i; 2647 2648 get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN); 2649 for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) { 2650 buf[i] &= ~mask[i]; 2651 buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i]; 2652 } 2653 } 2654 2655 /** 2656 * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match 2657 * 2658 * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match 2659 * or no match (RSSI only) 2660 * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match 2661 * or no match (RSSI only) 2662 * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm) 2663 * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied 2664 * for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertise this support 2665 * of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability 2666 * %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band 2667 * specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified. 2668 * If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of 2669 * corresponding matchset. 2670 */ 2671 struct cfg80211_match_set { 2672 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 2673 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2674 s32 rssi_thold; 2675 s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 2676 }; 2677 2678 /** 2679 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan 2680 * 2681 * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds. 2682 * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means 2683 * infinite loop. 2684 * The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero, 2685 * all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations. 2686 */ 2687 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan { 2688 u32 interval; 2689 u32 iterations; 2690 }; 2691 2692 /** 2693 * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment. 2694 * 2695 * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment. 2696 * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment. 2697 */ 2698 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust { 2699 enum nl80211_band band; 2700 s8 delta; 2701 }; 2702 2703 /** 2704 * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description 2705 * 2706 * @reqid: identifies this request. 2707 * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans) 2708 * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs 2709 * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan 2710 * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL 2711 * @ie_len: length of ie in octets 2712 * @flags: control flags from &enum nl80211_scan_flags 2713 * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result 2714 * entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host 2715 * (others are filtered out). 2716 * If omitted, all results are passed. 2717 * @n_match_sets: number of match sets 2718 * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request 2719 * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for 2720 * @dev: the interface 2721 * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan 2722 * @channels: channels to scan 2723 * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this 2724 * contains the minimum over all matchsets 2725 * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation 2726 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that 2727 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 2728 * be taken from the @mac_addr 2729 * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest 2730 * index must be executed first. 2731 * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1. 2732 * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct 2733 * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request 2734 * owned by a particular socket) 2735 * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed 2736 * @list: for keeping list of requests. 2737 * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan 2738 * cycle. The driver may ignore this parameter and start 2739 * immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not 2740 * supported. 2741 * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not. 2742 * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result 2743 * reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined 2744 * to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS. 2745 * The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state. 2746 * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong 2747 * to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported 2748 * using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that 2749 * belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative 2750 * comparisons. 2751 */ 2752 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request { 2753 u64 reqid; 2754 struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids; 2755 int n_ssids; 2756 u32 n_channels; 2757 const u8 *ie; 2758 size_t ie_len; 2759 u32 flags; 2760 struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets; 2761 int n_match_sets; 2762 s32 min_rssi_thold; 2763 u32 delay; 2764 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans; 2765 int n_scan_plans; 2766 2767 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2768 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2769 2770 bool relative_rssi_set; 2771 s8 relative_rssi; 2772 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust; 2773 2774 /* internal */ 2775 struct wiphy *wiphy; 2776 struct net_device *dev; 2777 unsigned long scan_start; 2778 bool report_results; 2779 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2780 u32 owner_nlportid; 2781 bool nl_owner_dead; 2782 struct list_head list; 2783 2784 /* keep last */ 2785 struct ieee80211_channel *channels[]; 2786 }; 2787 2788 /** 2789 * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type 2790 * 2791 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available 2792 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm) 2793 * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100 2794 */ 2795 enum cfg80211_signal_type { 2796 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE, 2797 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, 2798 CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC, 2799 }; 2800 2801 /** 2802 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data 2803 * @chan: channel the frame was received on 2804 * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's 2805 * signal type 2806 * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was 2807 * received; should match the time when the frame was actually 2808 * received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was 2809 * buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms. 2810 * If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of 2811 * ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate. 2812 * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the 2813 * timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified 2814 * by %parent_bssid. 2815 * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to 2816 * the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received. 2817 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2818 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2819 * @drv_data: Data to be passed through to @inform_bss 2820 */ 2821 struct cfg80211_inform_bss { 2822 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 2823 s32 signal; 2824 u64 boottime_ns; 2825 u64 parent_tsf; 2826 u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 2827 u8 chains; 2828 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2829 2830 void *drv_data; 2831 }; 2832 2833 /** 2834 * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data 2835 * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs 2836 * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing 2837 * @len: length of the IEs 2838 * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon 2839 * @data: IE data 2840 */ 2841 struct cfg80211_bss_ies { 2842 u64 tsf; 2843 struct rcu_head rcu_head; 2844 int len; 2845 bool from_beacon; 2846 u8 data[]; 2847 }; 2848 2849 /** 2850 * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description 2851 * 2852 * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network) 2853 * for use in scan results and similar. 2854 * 2855 * @channel: channel this BSS is on 2856 * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS 2857 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame 2858 * @capability: the capability field in host byte order 2859 * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these 2860 * are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or 2861 * proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been 2862 * received. It is always non-%NULL. 2863 * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame 2864 * (implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't 2865 * own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the 2866 * @hidden_beacon_bss struct) 2867 * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame 2868 * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from 2869 * a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct 2870 * that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and 2871 * points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case. 2872 * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a 2873 * non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support) 2874 * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one 2875 * (multi-BSSID support) 2876 * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type) 2877 * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal. 2878 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm. 2879 * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set 2880 * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set 2881 * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes 2882 */ 2883 struct cfg80211_bss { 2884 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 2885 2886 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies; 2887 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies; 2888 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies; 2889 2890 struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss; 2891 struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss; 2892 struct list_head nontrans_list; 2893 2894 s32 signal; 2895 2896 u16 beacon_interval; 2897 u16 capability; 2898 2899 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 2900 u8 chains; 2901 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS]; 2902 2903 u8 bssid_index; 2904 u8 max_bssid_indicator; 2905 2906 u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *)); 2907 }; 2908 2909 /** 2910 * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID 2911 * @bss: the bss to search 2912 * @id: the element ID 2913 * 2914 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2915 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2916 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2917 */ 2918 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id); 2919 2920 /** 2921 * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID 2922 * @bss: the bss to search 2923 * @id: the element ID 2924 * 2925 * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so 2926 * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function. 2927 * Return: %NULL if not found. 2928 */ 2929 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id) 2930 { 2931 return (const void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id); 2932 } 2933 2934 2935 /** 2936 * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data 2937 * 2938 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 2939 * authentication. 2940 * 2941 * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference 2942 * to it if it needs to keep it. 2943 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 2944 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL 2945 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 2946 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 2947 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 2948 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 2949 * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains 2950 * the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the 2951 * Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication 2952 * transaction sequence number field. 2953 * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets 2954 * @link_id: if >= 0, indicates authentication should be done as an MLD, 2955 * the interface address is included as the MLD address and the 2956 * necessary link (with the given link_id) will be created (and 2957 * given an MLD address) by the driver 2958 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of authentication request with 2959 * an AP MLD, valid iff @link_id >= 0 2960 */ 2961 struct cfg80211_auth_request { 2962 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2963 const u8 *ie; 2964 size_t ie_len; 2965 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 2966 const u8 *key; 2967 u8 key_len; 2968 s8 key_idx; 2969 const u8 *auth_data; 2970 size_t auth_data_len; 2971 s8 link_id; 2972 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 2973 }; 2974 2975 /** 2976 * struct cfg80211_assoc_link - per-link information for MLO association 2977 * @bss: the BSS pointer, see also &struct cfg80211_assoc_request::bss; 2978 * if this is %NULL for a link, that link is not requested 2979 * @elems: extra elements for the per-STA profile for this link 2980 * @elems_len: length of the elements 2981 * @disabled: If set this link should be included during association etc. but it 2982 * should not be used until enabled by the AP MLD. 2983 * @error: per-link error code, must be <= 0. If there is an error, then the 2984 * operation as a whole must fail. 2985 */ 2986 struct cfg80211_assoc_link { 2987 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 2988 const u8 *elems; 2989 size_t elems_len; 2990 bool disabled; 2991 int error; 2992 }; 2993 2994 /** 2995 * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association. 2996 * 2997 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT: Disable HT (802.11n) 2998 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT: Disable VHT 2999 * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association 3000 * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external 3001 * authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to 3002 * userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect() 3003 * request (connect callback). 3004 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE: Disable HE 3005 * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT: Disable EHT 3006 * @CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT: Userspace indicates support for handling MLD links. 3007 * Drivers shall disable MLO features for the current association if this 3008 * flag is not set. 3009 */ 3010 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags { 3011 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT = BIT(0), 3012 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT = BIT(1), 3013 ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM = BIT(2), 3014 CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(3), 3015 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE = BIT(4), 3016 ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_EHT = BIT(5), 3017 CONNECT_REQ_MLO_SUPPORT = BIT(6), 3018 }; 3019 3020 /** 3021 * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data 3022 * 3023 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 3024 * (re)association. 3025 * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is 3026 * given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc() 3027 * or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new 3028 * association requests while already associating must be rejected. 3029 * This also applies to the @links.bss parameter, which is used instead 3030 * of this one (it is %NULL) for MLO associations. 3031 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL 3032 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 3033 * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association 3034 * @crypto: crypto settings 3035 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 3036 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 3037 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 3038 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 3039 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 3040 * frame. 3041 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 3042 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 3043 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 3044 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 3045 * @vht_capa: VHT capability override 3046 * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use 3047 * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or 3048 * %NULL if FILS is not used. 3049 * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets 3050 * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association 3051 * Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts 3052 * with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce. 3053 * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override 3054 * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask 3055 * @links: per-link information for MLO connections 3056 * @link_id: >= 0 for MLO connections, where links are given, and indicates 3057 * the link on which the association request should be sent 3058 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address in case of MLO association request, 3059 * valid iff @link_id >= 0 3060 */ 3061 struct cfg80211_assoc_request { 3062 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 3063 const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid; 3064 size_t ie_len; 3065 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 3066 bool use_mfp; 3067 u32 flags; 3068 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 3069 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 3070 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask; 3071 const u8 *fils_kek; 3072 size_t fils_kek_len; 3073 const u8 *fils_nonces; 3074 struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask; 3075 struct cfg80211_assoc_link links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 3076 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 3077 s8 link_id; 3078 }; 3079 3080 /** 3081 * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data 3082 * 3083 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 3084 * deauthentication. 3085 * 3086 * @bssid: the BSSID or AP MLD address to deauthenticate from 3087 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL 3088 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 3089 * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication 3090 * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and 3091 * do not set a deauth frame 3092 */ 3093 struct cfg80211_deauth_request { 3094 const u8 *bssid; 3095 const u8 *ie; 3096 size_t ie_len; 3097 u16 reason_code; 3098 bool local_state_change; 3099 }; 3100 3101 /** 3102 * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data 3103 * 3104 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 3105 * disassociation. 3106 * 3107 * @ap_addr: the BSSID or AP MLD address to disassociate from 3108 * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL 3109 * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets 3110 * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation 3111 * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no 3112 * Disassociation frame is to be transmitted. 3113 */ 3114 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request { 3115 const u8 *ap_addr; 3116 const u8 *ie; 3117 size_t ie_len; 3118 u16 reason_code; 3119 bool local_state_change; 3120 }; 3121 3122 /** 3123 * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters 3124 * 3125 * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss() 3126 * method. 3127 * 3128 * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null. 3129 * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero. 3130 * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not 3131 * search for IBSSs with a different BSSID. 3132 * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found 3133 * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for 3134 * IBSSs to join on other channels. 3135 * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon 3136 * @ie_len: length of that 3137 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use 3138 * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured 3139 * after joining 3140 * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e., 3141 * sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is 3142 * required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by 3143 * user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default. 3144 * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control 3145 * port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface. 3146 * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e. 3147 * changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required 3148 * to operate on DFS channels. 3149 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS 3150 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled) 3151 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 3152 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 3153 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 3154 * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of 3155 * CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys 3156 * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key 3157 */ 3158 struct cfg80211_ibss_params { 3159 const u8 *ssid; 3160 const u8 *bssid; 3161 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 3162 const u8 *ie; 3163 u8 ssid_len, ie_len; 3164 u16 beacon_interval; 3165 u32 basic_rates; 3166 bool channel_fixed; 3167 bool privacy; 3168 bool control_port; 3169 bool control_port_over_nl80211; 3170 bool userspace_handles_dfs; 3171 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 3172 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 3173 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 3174 struct key_params *wep_keys; 3175 int wep_tx_key; 3176 }; 3177 3178 /** 3179 * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection. 3180 * 3181 * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour. 3182 * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour. 3183 * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF. 3184 * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST. 3185 */ 3186 struct cfg80211_bss_selection { 3187 enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour; 3188 union { 3189 enum nl80211_band band_pref; 3190 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust; 3191 } param; 3192 }; 3193 3194 /** 3195 * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters 3196 * 3197 * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11 3198 * authentication and association. 3199 * 3200 * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based 3201 * on scan results) 3202 * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or 3203 * %NULL if not specified 3204 * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan 3205 * results) 3206 * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or 3207 * %NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is 3208 * allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS 3209 * to use. 3210 * @ssid: SSID 3211 * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets 3212 * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm) 3213 * @ie: IEs for association request 3214 * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets 3215 * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used 3216 * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used 3217 * @crypto: crypto settings 3218 * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication 3219 * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication 3220 * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication 3221 * @flags: See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags 3222 * @bg_scan_period: Background scan period in seconds 3223 * or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used. 3224 * @ht_capa: HT Capabilities over-rides. Values set in ht_capa_mask 3225 * will be used in ht_capa. Un-supported values will be ignored. 3226 * @ht_capa_mask: The bits of ht_capa which are to be used. 3227 * @vht_capa: VHT Capability overrides 3228 * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used. 3229 * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG 3230 * networks. 3231 * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection. 3232 * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used 3233 * to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request 3234 * do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to 3235 * the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is 3236 * included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request 3237 * frame. 3238 * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the 3239 * NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped 3240 * data IE. 3241 * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets. 3242 * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or 3243 * %NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and 3244 * is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 3245 * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets. 3246 * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP 3247 * messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE. 3248 * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional 3249 * keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified. 3250 * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets. 3251 * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver 3252 * offload of 4-way handshake. 3253 * @edmg: define the EDMG channels. 3254 * This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver 3255 * to choose from, based on BSS configuration. 3256 */ 3257 struct cfg80211_connect_params { 3258 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 3259 struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint; 3260 const u8 *bssid; 3261 const u8 *bssid_hint; 3262 const u8 *ssid; 3263 size_t ssid_len; 3264 enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type; 3265 const u8 *ie; 3266 size_t ie_len; 3267 bool privacy; 3268 enum nl80211_mfp mfp; 3269 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto; 3270 const u8 *key; 3271 u8 key_len, key_idx; 3272 u32 flags; 3273 int bg_scan_period; 3274 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa; 3275 struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask; 3276 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa; 3277 struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask; 3278 bool pbss; 3279 struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select; 3280 const u8 *prev_bssid; 3281 const u8 *fils_erp_username; 3282 size_t fils_erp_username_len; 3283 const u8 *fils_erp_realm; 3284 size_t fils_erp_realm_len; 3285 u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num; 3286 const u8 *fils_erp_rrk; 3287 size_t fils_erp_rrk_len; 3288 bool want_1x; 3289 struct ieee80211_edmg edmg; 3290 }; 3291 3292 /** 3293 * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated 3294 * 3295 * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that 3296 * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call. 3297 * 3298 * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated 3299 * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm, 3300 * username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated 3301 * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated 3302 */ 3303 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed { 3304 UPDATE_ASSOC_IES = BIT(0), 3305 UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO = BIT(1), 3306 UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE = BIT(2), 3307 }; 3308 3309 /** 3310 * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values 3311 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed 3312 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed 3313 * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed 3314 * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed 3315 * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed 3316 * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled 3317 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed 3318 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed 3319 * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum 3320 */ 3321 enum wiphy_params_flags { 3322 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT = 1 << 0, 3323 WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG = 1 << 1, 3324 WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD = 1 << 2, 3325 WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD = 1 << 3, 3326 WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS = 1 << 4, 3327 WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK = 1 << 5, 3328 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT = 1 << 6, 3329 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT = 1 << 7, 3330 WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM = 1 << 8, 3331 }; 3332 3333 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT 256 3334 3335 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */ 3336 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L 5000 3337 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H 12000 3338 3339 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */ 3340 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD 24000 3341 3342 /** 3343 * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association 3344 * 3345 * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA 3346 * caching. 3347 * 3348 * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL). 3349 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 3350 * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key 3351 * derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL. 3352 * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on 3353 * the hash algorithm used to generate this. 3354 * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS 3355 * cache identifier (may be %NULL). 3356 * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets. 3357 * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the 3358 * scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be 3359 * %NULL). 3360 * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds 3361 * (dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified. 3362 * The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after 3363 * expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on 3364 * expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK 3365 * used for it expires. 3366 * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of 3367 * PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified. 3368 * Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using 3369 * this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this 3370 * threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires. 3371 */ 3372 struct cfg80211_pmksa { 3373 const u8 *bssid; 3374 const u8 *pmkid; 3375 const u8 *pmk; 3376 size_t pmk_len; 3377 const u8 *ssid; 3378 size_t ssid_len; 3379 const u8 *cache_id; 3380 u32 pmk_lifetime; 3381 u8 pmk_reauth_threshold; 3382 }; 3383 3384 /** 3385 * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern 3386 * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes, 3387 * one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211 3388 * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1 3389 * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes) 3390 * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes) 3391 * 3392 * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of 3393 * memory, free @mask only! 3394 */ 3395 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern { 3396 const u8 *mask, *pattern; 3397 int pattern_len; 3398 int pkt_offset; 3399 }; 3400 3401 /** 3402 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters 3403 * 3404 * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation 3405 * @src: source IP address 3406 * @dst: destination IP address 3407 * @dst_mac: destination MAC address 3408 * @src_port: source port 3409 * @dst_port: destination port 3410 * @payload_len: data payload length 3411 * @payload: data payload buffer 3412 * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration 3413 * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets 3414 * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length 3415 * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data 3416 * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask 3417 * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer 3418 * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration 3419 */ 3420 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp { 3421 struct socket *sock; 3422 __be32 src, dst; 3423 u16 src_port, dst_port; 3424 u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN]; 3425 int payload_len; 3426 const u8 *payload; 3427 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq; 3428 u32 data_interval; 3429 u32 wake_len; 3430 const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask; 3431 u32 tokens_size; 3432 /* must be last, variable member */ 3433 struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok; 3434 }; 3435 3436 /** 3437 * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info 3438 * 3439 * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device. 3440 * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues 3441 * operating as normal during suspend 3442 * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected 3443 * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet 3444 * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern 3445 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 3446 * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure 3447 * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet 3448 * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake 3449 * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released 3450 * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h. 3451 * NULL if not configured. 3452 * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake. 3453 */ 3454 struct cfg80211_wowlan { 3455 bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 3456 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 3457 rfkill_release; 3458 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 3459 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp; 3460 int n_patterns; 3461 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config; 3462 }; 3463 3464 /** 3465 * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters 3466 * 3467 * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device. 3468 * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs. 3469 * @condition: condition for packet coalescence. 3470 * see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition. 3471 * @patterns: array of packet patterns 3472 * @n_patterns: number of patterns 3473 */ 3474 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules { 3475 int delay; 3476 enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition; 3477 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns; 3478 int n_patterns; 3479 }; 3480 3481 /** 3482 * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings 3483 * 3484 * This structure defines coalescing settings. 3485 * @rules: array of coalesce rules 3486 * @n_rules: number of rules 3487 */ 3488 struct cfg80211_coalesce { 3489 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules; 3490 int n_rules; 3491 }; 3492 3493 /** 3494 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match 3495 * 3496 * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up 3497 * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred. This 3498 * value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels. 3499 * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match 3500 * occurred (in MHz) 3501 */ 3502 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match { 3503 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3504 int n_channels; 3505 u32 channels[]; 3506 }; 3507 3508 /** 3509 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information 3510 * 3511 * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in 3512 * @matches. This value may be zero if the driver can't provide 3513 * match information. 3514 * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about 3515 * the matches that triggered the wake up. 3516 */ 3517 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info { 3518 int n_matches; 3519 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[]; 3520 }; 3521 3522 /** 3523 * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report 3524 * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected 3525 * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet 3526 * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure 3527 * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet 3528 * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake 3529 * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released 3530 * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern 3531 * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data 3532 * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length 3533 * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any. 3534 * @packet_80211: For pattern match, magic packet and other data 3535 * frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for 3536 * disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which 3537 * it is. 3538 * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received 3539 * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish 3540 * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens 3541 * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect 3542 */ 3543 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup { 3544 bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure, 3545 eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake, 3546 rfkill_release, packet_80211, 3547 tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens; 3548 s32 pattern_idx; 3549 u32 packet_present_len, packet_len; 3550 const void *packet; 3551 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect; 3552 }; 3553 3554 /** 3555 * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data 3556 * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes) 3557 * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes) 3558 * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes) 3559 * @kek_len: length of kek 3560 * @kck_len: length of kck 3561 * @akm: akm (oui, id) 3562 */ 3563 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data { 3564 const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr; 3565 u32 akm; 3566 u8 kek_len, kck_len; 3567 }; 3568 3569 /** 3570 * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information 3571 * 3572 * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE 3573 * 3574 * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value 3575 * @ie: Fast Transition IEs 3576 * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets 3577 */ 3578 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params { 3579 u16 md; 3580 const u8 *ie; 3581 size_t ie_len; 3582 }; 3583 3584 /** 3585 * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters 3586 * 3587 * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame 3588 * 3589 * @chan: channel to use 3590 * @offchan: indicates whether off channel operation is required 3591 * @wait: duration for ROC 3592 * @buf: buffer to transmit 3593 * @len: buffer length 3594 * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame 3595 * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack 3596 * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array 3597 * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame 3598 * @link_id: for MLO, the link ID to transmit on, -1 if not given; note 3599 * that the link ID isn't validated (much), it's in range but the 3600 * link might not exist (or be used by the receiver STA) 3601 */ 3602 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params { 3603 struct ieee80211_channel *chan; 3604 bool offchan; 3605 unsigned int wait; 3606 const u8 *buf; 3607 size_t len; 3608 bool no_cck; 3609 bool dont_wait_for_ack; 3610 int n_csa_offsets; 3611 const u16 *csa_offsets; 3612 int link_id; 3613 }; 3614 3615 /** 3616 * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception 3617 * 3618 * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition 3619 * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs 3620 */ 3621 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception { 3622 u8 dscp; 3623 u8 up; 3624 }; 3625 3626 /** 3627 * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority 3628 * 3629 * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3630 * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive 3631 */ 3632 struct cfg80211_dscp_range { 3633 u8 low; 3634 u8 high; 3635 }; 3636 3637 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */ 3638 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX 21 3639 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN 16 3640 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \ 3641 (IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX) 3642 3643 /** 3644 * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information 3645 * 3646 * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values 3647 * 3648 * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21) 3649 * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from 3650 * the user priority DSCP range definition 3651 * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority 3652 */ 3653 struct cfg80211_qos_map { 3654 u8 num_des; 3655 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX]; 3656 struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8]; 3657 }; 3658 3659 /** 3660 * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration 3661 * 3662 * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters 3663 * 3664 * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255) 3665 * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. 3666 * For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 3667 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 3668 */ 3669 struct cfg80211_nan_conf { 3670 u8 master_pref; 3671 u8 bands; 3672 }; 3673 3674 /** 3675 * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN 3676 * configuration 3677 * 3678 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference 3679 * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands 3680 */ 3681 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes { 3682 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0), 3683 CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1), 3684 }; 3685 3686 /** 3687 * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter 3688 * 3689 * @filter: the content of the filter 3690 * @len: the length of the filter 3691 */ 3692 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter { 3693 const u8 *filter; 3694 u8 len; 3695 }; 3696 3697 /** 3698 * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function 3699 * 3700 * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type 3701 * @service_id: the service ID of the function 3702 * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type 3703 * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is 3704 * implementation specific. 3705 * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted 3706 * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active 3707 * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up 3708 * @followup_reqid: the requester instance ID for follow up 3709 * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up 3710 * @ttl: time to live counter in DW. 3711 * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info 3712 * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length 3713 * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive 3714 * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter 3715 * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length 3716 * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index 3717 * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses 3718 * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF 3719 * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter 3720 * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF. 3721 * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters. 3722 * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters. 3723 * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function. 3724 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier. 3725 */ 3726 struct cfg80211_nan_func { 3727 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 3728 u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN]; 3729 u8 publish_type; 3730 bool close_range; 3731 bool publish_bcast; 3732 bool subscribe_active; 3733 u8 followup_id; 3734 u8 followup_reqid; 3735 struct mac_address followup_dest; 3736 u32 ttl; 3737 const u8 *serv_spec_info; 3738 u8 serv_spec_info_len; 3739 bool srf_include; 3740 const u8 *srf_bf; 3741 u8 srf_bf_len; 3742 u8 srf_bf_idx; 3743 struct mac_address *srf_macs; 3744 int srf_num_macs; 3745 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters; 3746 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters; 3747 u8 num_tx_filters; 3748 u8 num_rx_filters; 3749 u8 instance_id; 3750 u64 cookie; 3751 }; 3752 3753 /** 3754 * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration 3755 * 3756 * @aa: authenticator address 3757 * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes. 3758 * @pmk: the PMK material 3759 * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK 3760 * is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field 3761 * holds PMK-R0. 3762 */ 3763 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf { 3764 const u8 *aa; 3765 u8 pmk_len; 3766 const u8 *pmk; 3767 const u8 *pmk_r0_name; 3768 }; 3769 3770 /** 3771 * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication. 3772 * 3773 * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces. 3774 * 3775 * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant 3776 * for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space). 3777 * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has 3778 * to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and 3779 * authentication response command interface. 3780 * @ssid: SSID of the AP. Used by both the authentication request event and 3781 * authentication response command interface. 3782 * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the 3783 * authentication request event interface. 3784 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication, 3785 * use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you 3786 * the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication 3787 * response command interface (user space to driver). 3788 * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA. 3789 * @mld_addr: MLD address of the peer. Used by the authentication request event 3790 * interface. Driver indicates this to enable MLO during the authentication 3791 * offload to user space. Driver shall look at %NL80211_ATTR_MLO_SUPPORT 3792 * flag capability in NL80211_CMD_CONNECT to know whether the user space 3793 * supports enabling MLO during the authentication offload. 3794 * User space should use the address of the interface (on which the 3795 * authentication request event reported) as self MLD address. User space 3796 * and driver should use MLD addresses in RA, TA and BSSID fields of 3797 * authentication frames sent or received via cfg80211. The driver 3798 * translates the MLD addresses to/from link addresses based on the link 3799 * chosen for the authentication. 3800 */ 3801 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params { 3802 enum nl80211_external_auth_action action; 3803 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3804 struct cfg80211_ssid ssid; 3805 unsigned int key_mgmt_suite; 3806 u16 status; 3807 const u8 *pmkid; 3808 u8 mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 3809 }; 3810 3811 /** 3812 * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics 3813 * 3814 * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to 3815 * indicate the relevant values in this struct for them 3816 * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully 3817 * answered 3818 * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were 3819 * successfully answered 3820 * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions 3821 * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions 3822 * @non_asap_num: number of non-ASAP FTM sessions 3823 * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication 3824 * of how much time the responder was busy 3825 * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from 3826 * initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with 3827 * the responder 3828 * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks 3829 * for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot 3830 * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window 3831 */ 3832 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats { 3833 u32 filled; 3834 u32 success_num; 3835 u32 partial_num; 3836 u32 failed_num; 3837 u32 asap_num; 3838 u32 non_asap_num; 3839 u64 total_duration_ms; 3840 u32 unknown_triggers_num; 3841 u32 reschedule_requests_num; 3842 u32 out_of_window_triggers_num; 3843 }; 3844 3845 /** 3846 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result 3847 * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is 3848 * %NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise 3849 * reason than just "failure" 3850 * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index 3851 * in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported 3852 * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted 3853 * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked 3854 * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY, 3855 * fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible 3856 * by the responder 3857 * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated 3858 * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated 3859 * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated 3860 * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present) 3861 * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present) 3862 * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL) 3863 * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL) 3864 * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3865 * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported 3866 * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response 3867 * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame 3868 * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg) 3869 * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is 3870 * the square root of the variance) 3871 * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured 3872 * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured 3873 * (must have either this or @rtt_avg) 3874 * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance) 3875 * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread) 3876 * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid 3877 * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid 3878 * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid 3879 * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid 3880 * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid 3881 * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid 3882 * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid 3883 * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid 3884 * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid 3885 * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid 3886 * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid 3887 * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid 3888 */ 3889 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result { 3890 const u8 *lci; 3891 const u8 *civicloc; 3892 unsigned int lci_len; 3893 unsigned int civicloc_len; 3894 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason; 3895 u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes; 3896 s16 burst_index; 3897 u8 busy_retry_time; 3898 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3899 u8 burst_duration; 3900 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3901 s32 rssi_avg; 3902 s32 rssi_spread; 3903 struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate; 3904 s64 rtt_avg; 3905 s64 rtt_variance; 3906 s64 rtt_spread; 3907 s64 dist_avg; 3908 s64 dist_variance; 3909 s64 dist_spread; 3910 3911 u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1, 3912 num_ftmr_successes_valid:1, 3913 rssi_avg_valid:1, 3914 rssi_spread_valid:1, 3915 tx_rate_valid:1, 3916 rx_rate_valid:1, 3917 rtt_avg_valid:1, 3918 rtt_variance_valid:1, 3919 rtt_spread_valid:1, 3920 dist_avg_valid:1, 3921 dist_variance_valid:1, 3922 dist_spread_valid:1; 3923 }; 3924 3925 /** 3926 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result 3927 * @addr: address of the peer 3928 * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the 3929 * measurement was made) 3930 * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time 3931 * @status: status of the measurement 3932 * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not 3933 * reporting partial results always set this flag 3934 * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid 3935 * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting 3936 * one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and 3937 * they're all aggregated for userspace. 3938 * @ftm: FTM result 3939 */ 3940 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result { 3941 u64 host_time, ap_tsf; 3942 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status; 3943 3944 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 3945 3946 u8 final:1, 3947 ap_tsf_valid:1; 3948 3949 enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type; 3950 3951 union { 3952 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm; 3953 }; 3954 }; 3955 3956 /** 3957 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data 3958 * @requested: indicates FTM is requested 3959 * @preamble: frame preamble to use 3960 * @burst_period: burst period to use 3961 * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode 3962 * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent 3963 * @burst_duration: burst duration 3964 * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst 3965 * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request 3966 * @request_lci: request LCI information 3967 * @request_civicloc: request civic location information 3968 * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement 3969 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3970 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3971 * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement 3972 * If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set, 3973 * EDCA based ranging will be used. 3974 * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either 3975 * @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set. 3976 * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to 3977 * indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if 3978 * @non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set. 3979 * 3980 * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation. 3981 */ 3982 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer { 3983 enum nl80211_preamble preamble; 3984 u16 burst_period; 3985 u8 requested:1, 3986 asap:1, 3987 request_lci:1, 3988 request_civicloc:1, 3989 trigger_based:1, 3990 non_trigger_based:1, 3991 lmr_feedback:1; 3992 u8 num_bursts_exp; 3993 u8 burst_duration; 3994 u8 ftms_per_burst; 3995 u8 ftmr_retries; 3996 u8 bss_color; 3997 }; 3998 3999 /** 4000 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request 4001 * @addr: MAC address 4002 * @chandef: channel to use 4003 * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF 4004 * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer 4005 */ 4006 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer { 4007 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN]; 4008 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 4009 u8 report_ap_tsf:1; 4010 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm; 4011 }; 4012 4013 /** 4014 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request 4015 * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211 4016 * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211 4017 * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting, 4018 * not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211 4019 * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request 4020 * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that 4021 * are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should 4022 * be taken from the @mac_addr 4023 * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request 4024 * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if 4025 * zero it means there's no timeout 4026 * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with 4027 * @peers: per-peer measurement request data 4028 */ 4029 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request { 4030 u64 cookie; 4031 void *drv_data; 4032 u32 n_peers; 4033 u32 nl_portid; 4034 4035 u32 timeout; 4036 4037 u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 4038 u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 4039 4040 struct list_head list; 4041 4042 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[] __counted_by(n_peers); 4043 }; 4044 4045 /** 4046 * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information 4047 * 4048 * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE 4049 * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space. 4050 * 4051 * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces. 4052 * 4053 * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing 4054 * has to be done. 4055 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info 4056 * processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space 4057 * cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for 4058 * OWE update request command interface (user space to driver). 4059 * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are 4060 * the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and 4061 * the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface. 4062 * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets. 4063 * @assoc_link_id: MLO link ID of the AP, with which (re)association requested 4064 * by peer. This will be filled by driver for both MLO and non-MLO station 4065 * connections when the AP affiliated with an MLD. For non-MLD AP mode, it 4066 * will be -1. Used only with OWE update event (driver to user space). 4067 * @peer_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the peer. For non-MLO 4068 * connection, it will be all zeros. This is applicable only when 4069 * @assoc_link_id is not -1, i.e., the AP affiliated with an MLD. Used only 4070 * with OWE update event (driver to user space). 4071 */ 4072 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info { 4073 u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 4074 u16 status; 4075 const u8 *ie; 4076 size_t ie_len; 4077 int assoc_link_id; 4078 u8 peer_mld_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 4079 }; 4080 4081 /** 4082 * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data 4083 * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 4084 * for the entire device 4085 * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered 4086 * for the given interface 4087 * @global_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes 4088 * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface 4089 * for these subtypes 4090 */ 4091 struct mgmt_frame_regs { 4092 u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes; 4093 u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes; 4094 }; 4095 4096 /** 4097 * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration 4098 * 4099 * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks 4100 * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces. 4101 * 4102 * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0 4103 * on success or a negative error code. 4104 * 4105 * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be 4106 * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied 4107 * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering, 4108 * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers. 4109 * 4110 * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will 4111 * be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are 4112 * configured for the device. 4113 * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed 4114 * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback 4115 * to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from 4116 * the device. 4117 * 4118 * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name, 4119 * must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create 4120 * the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct 4121 * wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must 4122 * also set the address member in the wdev. 4123 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 4124 * 4125 * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface 4126 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 4127 * 4128 * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface, 4129 * keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated. 4130 * This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes. 4131 * 4132 * @add_intf_link: Add a new MLO link to the given interface. Note that 4133 * the wdev->link[] data structure has been updated, so the new link 4134 * address is available. 4135 * @del_intf_link: Remove an MLO link from the given interface. 4136 * 4137 * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL 4138 * when adding a group key. @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. 4139 * For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for 4140 * pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. 4141 * 4142 * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters. 4143 * @mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group 4144 * key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid 4145 * after it returns. This function should return an error if it is 4146 * not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist. 4147 * @link_id will be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, 4148 * @link_id will be >= 0 for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr 4149 * will be peer's MLD address for MLO pairwise key. 4150 * 4151 * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key) 4152 * and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist. @link_id will 4153 * be -1 for non-MLO connection. For MLO connection, @link_id will be >= 0 4154 * for group key and -1 for pairwise key, @mac_addr will be peer's MLD 4155 * address for MLO pairwise key. 4156 * 4157 * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface. @link_id will be >= 0 4158 * for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection. 4159 * 4160 * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface. 4161 * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection. 4162 * 4163 * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface. 4164 * @link_id will be >= 0 for MLO connection and -1 for non-MLO connection. 4165 * 4166 * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver 4167 * 4168 * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters. 4169 * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode 4170 * interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started. 4171 * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing. 4172 * 4173 * @add_station: Add a new station. 4174 * @del_station: Remove a station 4175 * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much 4176 * validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags 4177 * might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check 4178 * them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call 4179 * cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information. 4180 * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac 4181 * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx 4182 * 4183 * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path 4184 * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path 4185 * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path 4186 * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters 4187 * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 4188 * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters 4189 * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx 4190 * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters 4191 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4192 * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network 4193 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4194 * 4195 * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration 4196 * 4197 * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh. 4198 * The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to 4199 * set, and which to leave alone. 4200 * 4201 * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS. 4202 * 4203 * @inform_bss: Called by cfg80211 while being informed about new BSS data 4204 * for every BSS found within the reported data or frame. This is called 4205 * from within the cfg8011 inform_bss handlers while holding the bss_lock. 4206 * The data parameter is passed through from drv_data inside 4207 * struct cfg80211_inform_bss. 4208 * The new IE data for the BSS is explicitly passed. 4209 * 4210 * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters 4211 * 4212 * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas, 4213 * as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to 4214 * join the mesh instead. 4215 * 4216 * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other 4217 * interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration. 4218 * If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should 4219 * be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active. 4220 * 4221 * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given 4222 * the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done(). 4223 * For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside 4224 * the scan/scan_done bracket too. 4225 * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall 4226 * indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done(). 4227 * 4228 * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer 4229 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4230 * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer 4231 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4232 * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer 4233 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4234 * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer 4235 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4236 * 4237 * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected, 4238 * call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code 4239 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call 4240 * cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code 4241 * from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code 4242 * was received. 4243 * The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the 4244 * other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated 4245 * by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches 4246 * the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request 4247 * frame instead of Association Request frame. 4248 * The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a 4249 * specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid 4250 * parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an 4251 * indication of requesting reassociation. 4252 * In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming 4253 * cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to 4254 * cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4255 * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a 4256 * BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for 4257 * subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the 4258 * Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not 4259 * request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current 4260 * BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in 4261 * changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed. 4262 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4263 * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if 4264 * connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in 4265 * case connection was already established (invoked with the 4266 * wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout(). 4267 * 4268 * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call 4269 * cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due 4270 * to a merge. 4271 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4272 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS. 4273 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4274 * 4275 * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or 4276 * MESH mode) 4277 * 4278 * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed; 4279 * @changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values 4280 * have changed. The actual parameter values are available in 4281 * struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed. 4282 * 4283 * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters, 4284 * the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The 4285 * wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will 4286 * always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power 4287 * (as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.) 4288 * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable; 4289 * return 0 if successful 4290 * 4291 * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting 4292 * functions to adjust rfkill hw state 4293 * 4294 * @dump_survey: get site survey information. 4295 * 4296 * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified 4297 * channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel 4298 * operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is 4299 * ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event 4300 * notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel(). 4301 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation. 4302 * This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on 4303 * the duration value. 4304 * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame. 4305 * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management 4306 * frame on another channel 4307 * 4308 * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL 4309 * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be 4310 * used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally, 4311 * return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the 4312 * dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data 4313 * was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present 4314 * and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA. 4315 * 4316 * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration 4317 * 4318 * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac 4319 * devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association 4320 * RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs. 4321 * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID. 4322 * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs. 4323 * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1 4324 * allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value. 4325 * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold. 4326 * After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating 4327 * the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may 4328 * need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being 4329 * disabled.) 4330 * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the 4331 * connection quality monitor. An event is to be sent only when the 4332 * signal level is found to be outside the two values. The driver should 4333 * set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented. 4334 * If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config. 4335 * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error 4336 * thresholds. 4337 * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan. 4338 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with 4339 * given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready 4340 * for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be 4341 * called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case. 4342 * The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested 4343 * stop (when this method returns 0). 4344 * 4345 * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame 4346 * registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep. 4347 * 4348 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device. 4349 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may 4350 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL 4351 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX). 4352 * 4353 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant). 4354 * 4355 * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame. 4356 * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup). 4357 * 4358 * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it 4359 * later passes to cfg80211_probe_status(). 4360 * 4361 * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs. 4362 * 4363 * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface. 4364 * For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single 4365 * current monitoring channel. 4366 * 4367 * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device. 4368 * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device. 4369 * 4370 * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode. 4371 * Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations 4372 * and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver 4373 * this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL 4374 * when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which 4375 * advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback. 4376 * 4377 * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver. 4378 * 4379 * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC 4380 * was finished on another phy. 4381 * 4382 * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the 4383 * driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be 4384 * used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames. 4385 * 4386 * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability 4387 * for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the 4388 * driver can take the most appropriate actions. 4389 * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link 4390 * reliability. This operation can not fail. 4391 * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters. 4392 * 4393 * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is 4394 * responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is 4395 * inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later 4396 * with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept 4397 * everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them 4398 * as soon as possible. 4399 * 4400 * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver 4401 * 4402 * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the 4403 * given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width 4404 * changes during the lifetime of the BSS. 4405 * 4406 * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device 4407 * with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by 4408 * userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into 4409 * account. 4410 * If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure 4411 * the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return 4412 * success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake 4413 * with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later 4414 * rejected) 4415 * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS 4416 * 4417 * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters 4418 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4419 * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network 4420 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4421 * 4422 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver 4423 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations 4424 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. 4425 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both 4426 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes. 4427 * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface. 4428 * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface. 4429 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure. 4430 * On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and 4431 * it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver 4432 * should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling 4433 * cfg80211_free_nan_func(). 4434 * On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the 4435 * provided @nan_func. 4436 * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function. 4437 * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must 4438 * be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes); 4439 * All other parameters must be ignored. 4440 * 4441 * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS 4442 * 4443 * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this 4444 * function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise. 4445 * 4446 * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake. 4447 * If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect 4448 * upon which the driver should clear it. 4449 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4450 * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator. 4451 * (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held) 4452 * 4453 * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from 4454 * user space 4455 * 4456 * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL). The noencrypt parameter 4457 * tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted. 4458 * 4459 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available. 4460 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided. 4461 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) 4462 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement 4463 * 4464 * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME 4465 * but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated 4466 * DH IE through this interface. 4467 * 4468 * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame 4469 * and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm. 4470 * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific 4471 * This callback may sleep. 4472 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the 4473 * given TIDs. This callback may sleep. 4474 * 4475 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings. 4476 * 4477 * @color_change: Initiate a color change. 4478 * 4479 * @set_fils_aad: Set FILS AAD data to the AP driver so that the driver can use 4480 * those to decrypt (Re)Association Request and encrypt (Re)Association 4481 * Response frame. 4482 * 4483 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for 4484 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit 4485 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev. 4486 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime 4487 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected 4488 * radar channel. 4489 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to 4490 * disable background CAC/radar detection. 4491 * @add_link_station: Add a link to a station. 4492 * @mod_link_station: Modify a link of a station. 4493 * @del_link_station: Remove a link of a station. 4494 * 4495 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. 4496 */ 4497 struct cfg80211_ops { 4498 int (*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow); 4499 int (*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 4500 void (*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled); 4501 4502 struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4503 const char *name, 4504 unsigned char name_assign_type, 4505 enum nl80211_iftype type, 4506 struct vif_params *params); 4507 int (*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4508 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4509 int (*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4510 struct net_device *dev, 4511 enum nl80211_iftype type, 4512 struct vif_params *params); 4513 4514 int (*add_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4515 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4516 unsigned int link_id); 4517 void (*del_intf_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4518 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4519 unsigned int link_id); 4520 4521 int (*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4522 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise, 4523 const u8 *mac_addr, struct key_params *params); 4524 int (*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4525 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise, 4526 const u8 *mac_addr, void *cookie, 4527 void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*)); 4528 int (*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4529 int link_id, u8 key_index, bool pairwise, 4530 const u8 *mac_addr); 4531 int (*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4532 struct net_device *netdev, int link_id, 4533 u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast); 4534 int (*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4535 struct net_device *netdev, int link_id, 4536 u8 key_index); 4537 int (*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4538 struct net_device *netdev, 4539 int link_id, 4540 u8 key_index); 4541 4542 int (*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4543 struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings); 4544 int (*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4545 struct cfg80211_ap_update *info); 4546 int (*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4547 unsigned int link_id); 4548 4549 4550 int (*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4551 const u8 *mac, 4552 struct station_parameters *params); 4553 int (*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4554 struct station_del_parameters *params); 4555 int (*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4556 const u8 *mac, 4557 struct station_parameters *params); 4558 int (*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4559 const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 4560 int (*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4561 int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo); 4562 4563 int (*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4564 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 4565 int (*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4566 const u8 *dst); 4567 int (*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4568 const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop); 4569 int (*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4570 u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4571 int (*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4572 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, 4573 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4574 int (*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4575 u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4576 int (*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4577 int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, 4578 struct mpath_info *pinfo); 4579 int (*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4580 struct net_device *dev, 4581 struct mesh_config *conf); 4582 int (*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4583 struct net_device *dev, u32 mask, 4584 const struct mesh_config *nconf); 4585 int (*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4586 const struct mesh_config *conf, 4587 const struct mesh_setup *setup); 4588 int (*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4589 4590 int (*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4591 struct ocb_setup *setup); 4592 int (*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4593 4594 int (*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4595 struct bss_parameters *params); 4596 4597 void (*inform_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 4598 const struct cfg80211_bss_ies *ies, void *data); 4599 4600 int (*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4601 struct ieee80211_txq_params *params); 4602 4603 int (*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4604 struct net_device *dev, 4605 struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 4606 4607 int (*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4608 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4609 4610 int (*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4611 struct cfg80211_scan_request *request); 4612 void (*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4613 4614 int (*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4615 struct cfg80211_auth_request *req); 4616 int (*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4617 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req); 4618 int (*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4619 struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req); 4620 int (*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4621 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req); 4622 4623 int (*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4624 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme); 4625 int (*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4626 struct net_device *dev, 4627 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme, 4628 u32 changed); 4629 int (*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4630 u16 reason_code); 4631 4632 int (*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4633 struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params); 4634 int (*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev); 4635 4636 int (*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4637 int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]); 4638 4639 int (*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed); 4640 4641 int (*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4642 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm); 4643 int (*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4644 int *dbm); 4645 4646 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy); 4647 4648 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 4649 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4650 void *data, int len); 4651 int (*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb, 4652 struct netlink_callback *cb, 4653 void *data, int len); 4654 #endif 4655 4656 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4657 struct net_device *dev, 4658 unsigned int link_id, 4659 const u8 *peer, 4660 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask); 4661 4662 int (*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4663 int idx, struct survey_info *info); 4664 4665 int (*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4666 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4667 int (*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev, 4668 struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa); 4669 int (*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev); 4670 4671 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4672 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4673 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 4674 unsigned int duration, 4675 u64 *cookie); 4676 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4677 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4678 u64 cookie); 4679 4680 int (*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4681 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params, 4682 u64 *cookie); 4683 int (*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4684 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4685 u64 cookie); 4686 4687 int (*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4688 bool enabled, int timeout); 4689 4690 int (*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4691 struct net_device *dev, 4692 s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst); 4693 4694 int (*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4695 struct net_device *dev, 4696 s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high); 4697 4698 int (*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4699 struct net_device *dev, 4700 u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl); 4701 4702 void (*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4703 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4704 struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd); 4705 4706 int (*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant); 4707 int (*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant); 4708 4709 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4710 struct net_device *dev, 4711 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request); 4712 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4713 u64 reqid); 4714 4715 int (*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4716 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data); 4717 4718 int (*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4719 const u8 *peer, int link_id, 4720 u8 action_code, u8 dialog_token, u16 status_code, 4721 u32 peer_capability, bool initiator, 4722 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4723 int (*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4724 const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper); 4725 4726 int (*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4727 const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie); 4728 4729 int (*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4730 struct net_device *dev, 4731 u16 noack_map); 4732 4733 int (*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4734 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4735 unsigned int link_id, 4736 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4737 4738 int (*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4739 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4740 void (*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4741 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4742 4743 int (*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4744 const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params); 4745 4746 int (*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4747 struct net_device *dev, 4748 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 4749 u32 cac_time_ms); 4750 void (*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4751 struct net_device *dev); 4752 int (*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4753 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie); 4754 int (*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4755 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4756 enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol, 4757 u16 duration); 4758 void (*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4759 struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4760 int (*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4761 struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce); 4762 4763 int (*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4764 struct net_device *dev, 4765 struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params); 4766 4767 int (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4768 struct net_device *dev, 4769 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 4770 4771 int (*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4772 unsigned int link_id, 4773 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4774 4775 int (*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4776 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio, 4777 u16 admitted_time); 4778 int (*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4779 u8 tsid, const u8 *peer); 4780 4781 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4782 struct net_device *dev, 4783 const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class, 4784 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4785 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4786 struct net_device *dev, 4787 const u8 *addr); 4788 int (*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4789 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf); 4790 void (*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev); 4791 int (*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4792 struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func); 4793 void (*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4794 u64 cookie); 4795 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4796 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4797 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, 4798 u32 changes); 4799 4800 int (*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4801 struct net_device *dev, 4802 const bool enabled); 4803 4804 int (*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4805 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4806 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats); 4807 4808 int (*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4809 const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf); 4810 int (*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4811 const u8 *aa); 4812 int (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4813 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params); 4814 4815 int (*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4816 struct net_device *dev, 4817 const u8 *buf, size_t len, 4818 const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto, 4819 const bool noencrypt, int link_id, 4820 u64 *cookie); 4821 4822 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4823 struct net_device *dev, 4824 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats); 4825 4826 int (*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4827 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4828 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 4829 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request); 4830 int (*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4831 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info); 4832 int (*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4833 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 4834 int (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4835 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf); 4836 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4837 const u8 *peer, u8 tids); 4838 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4839 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar); 4840 int (*color_change)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4841 struct net_device *dev, 4842 struct cfg80211_color_change_settings *params); 4843 int (*set_fils_aad)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4844 struct cfg80211_fils_aad *fils_aad); 4845 int (*set_radar_background)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 4846 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 4847 int (*add_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4848 struct link_station_parameters *params); 4849 int (*mod_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4850 struct link_station_parameters *params); 4851 int (*del_link_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4852 struct link_station_del_parameters *params); 4853 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev, 4854 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts); 4855 }; 4856 4857 /* 4858 * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures 4859 * and registration/helper functions 4860 */ 4861 4862 /** 4863 * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags 4864 * 4865 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split 4866 * into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB. 4867 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this 4868 * wiphy at all 4869 * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled 4870 * by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default 4871 * on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good 4872 * reason to override the default 4873 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station 4874 * on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of 4875 * supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype. 4876 * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station 4877 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the 4878 * control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the 4879 * control_port_no_encrypt flag. 4880 * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN. 4881 * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing 4882 * auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH. 4883 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the 4884 * firmware. 4885 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP. 4886 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation. 4887 * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z) 4888 * link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and 4889 * teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT 4890 * command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be 4891 * used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation. 4892 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME 4893 * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes 4894 * when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling 4895 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(). 4896 * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device 4897 * responds to probe-requests in hardware. 4898 * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX. 4899 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call. 4900 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels. 4901 * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in 4902 * beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...). 4903 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys 4904 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO: This is a temporary flag gating the MLO APIs, 4905 * in order to not have them reachable in normal drivers, until we have 4906 * complete feature/interface combinations/etc. advertisement. No driver 4907 * should set this flag for now. 4908 * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32: The device supports 32-byte KCK keys. 4909 * @WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER: The device could handle reg notify for 4910 * NL80211_REGDOM_SET_BY_DRIVER. 4911 * @WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON: reg_call_notifier() is called if driver 4912 * set this flag to update channels on beacon hints. 4913 */ 4914 enum wiphy_flags { 4915 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK = BIT(0), 4916 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_MLO = BIT(1), 4917 WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ = BIT(2), 4918 WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK = BIT(3), 4919 WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT = BIT(4), 4920 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP = BIT(5), 4921 WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION = BIT(6), 4922 WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL = BIT(7), 4923 WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN = BIT(8), 4924 WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH = BIT(10), 4925 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KCK_32 = BIT(11), 4926 /* use hole at 12 */ 4927 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM = BIT(13), 4928 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD = BIT(14), 4929 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS = BIT(15), 4930 WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP = BIT(16), 4931 WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME = BIT(17), 4932 WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS = BIT(18), 4933 WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD = BIT(19), 4934 WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX = BIT(20), 4935 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL = BIT(21), 4936 WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ = BIT(22), 4937 WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH = BIT(23), 4938 WIPHY_FLAG_NOTIFY_REGDOM_BY_DRIVER = BIT(24), 4939 WIPHY_FLAG_CHANNEL_CHANGE_ON_BEACON = BIT(25), 4940 }; 4941 4942 /** 4943 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types 4944 * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types 4945 * @types: interface types (bits) 4946 */ 4947 struct ieee80211_iface_limit { 4948 u16 max; 4949 u16 types; 4950 }; 4951 4952 /** 4953 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination 4954 * 4955 * With this structure the driver can describe which interface 4956 * combinations it supports concurrently. 4957 * 4958 * Examples: 4959 * 4960 * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total: 4961 * 4962 * .. code-block:: c 4963 * 4964 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = { 4965 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 4966 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP), }, 4967 * }; 4968 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = { 4969 * .limits = limits1, 4970 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1), 4971 * .max_interfaces = 2, 4972 * .beacon_int_infra_match = true, 4973 * }; 4974 * 4975 * 4976 * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total: 4977 * 4978 * .. code-block:: c 4979 * 4980 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = { 4981 * { .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) | 4982 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), }, 4983 * }; 4984 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = { 4985 * .limits = limits2, 4986 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2), 4987 * .max_interfaces = 8, 4988 * .num_different_channels = 1, 4989 * }; 4990 * 4991 * 4992 * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total. 4993 * 4994 * This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections. 4995 * 4996 * .. code-block:: c 4997 * 4998 * struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = { 4999 * { .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), }, 5000 * { .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) | 5001 * BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), }, 5002 * }; 5003 * struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = { 5004 * .limits = limits3, 5005 * .n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3), 5006 * .max_interfaces = 4, 5007 * .num_different_channels = 2, 5008 * }; 5009 * 5010 */ 5011 struct ieee80211_iface_combination { 5012 /** 5013 * @limits: 5014 * limits for the given interface types 5015 */ 5016 const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits; 5017 5018 /** 5019 * @num_different_channels: 5020 * can use up to this many different channels 5021 */ 5022 u32 num_different_channels; 5023 5024 /** 5025 * @max_interfaces: 5026 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group 5027 */ 5028 u16 max_interfaces; 5029 5030 /** 5031 * @n_limits: 5032 * number of limitations 5033 */ 5034 u8 n_limits; 5035 5036 /** 5037 * @beacon_int_infra_match: 5038 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure 5039 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases. 5040 */ 5041 bool beacon_int_infra_match; 5042 5043 /** 5044 * @radar_detect_widths: 5045 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection 5046 */ 5047 u8 radar_detect_widths; 5048 5049 /** 5050 * @radar_detect_regions: 5051 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection 5052 */ 5053 u8 radar_detect_regions; 5054 5055 /** 5056 * @beacon_int_min_gcd: 5057 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals. 5058 * 5059 * = 0 5060 * all beacon intervals for different interface must be same. 5061 * > 0 5062 * any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND 5063 * GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this 5064 * combination must be greater or equal to this value. 5065 */ 5066 u32 beacon_int_min_gcd; 5067 }; 5068 5069 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes { 5070 u16 tx, rx; 5071 }; 5072 5073 /** 5074 * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags 5075 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any" 5076 * trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and 5077 * wakes up the host on any activity, for example a 5078 * received packet that passed filtering; note that the 5079 * packet should be preserved in that case 5080 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet 5081 * (see nl80211.h) 5082 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect 5083 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep 5084 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure 5085 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request 5086 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure 5087 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release 5088 * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection 5089 */ 5090 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags { 5091 WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY = BIT(0), 5092 WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT = BIT(1), 5093 WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT = BIT(2), 5094 WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY = BIT(3), 5095 WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE = BIT(4), 5096 WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ = BIT(5), 5097 WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE = BIT(6), 5098 WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE = BIT(7), 5099 WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT = BIT(8), 5100 }; 5101 5102 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support { 5103 const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok; 5104 u32 data_payload_max; 5105 u32 data_interval_max; 5106 u32 wake_payload_max; 5107 bool seq; 5108 }; 5109 5110 /** 5111 * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data 5112 * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags 5113 * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns 5114 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 5115 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 5116 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 5117 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 5118 * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect, 5119 * similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for 5120 * scheduled scans. 5121 * See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more 5122 * details. 5123 * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information 5124 */ 5125 struct wiphy_wowlan_support { 5126 u32 flags; 5127 int n_patterns; 5128 int pattern_max_len; 5129 int pattern_min_len; 5130 int max_pkt_offset; 5131 int max_nd_match_sets; 5132 const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp; 5133 }; 5134 5135 /** 5136 * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data 5137 * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules 5138 * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs 5139 * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule 5140 * (see nl80211.h for the pattern definition) 5141 * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern 5142 * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern 5143 * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset 5144 */ 5145 struct wiphy_coalesce_support { 5146 int n_rules; 5147 int max_delay; 5148 int n_patterns; 5149 int pattern_max_len; 5150 int pattern_min_len; 5151 int max_pkt_offset; 5152 }; 5153 5154 /** 5155 * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands 5156 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev 5157 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev 5158 * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running 5159 * (must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV) 5160 */ 5161 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags { 5162 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0), 5163 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1), 5164 WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2), 5165 }; 5166 5167 /** 5168 * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags 5169 * 5170 * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed 5171 * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed 5172 * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed 5173 * 5174 */ 5175 enum wiphy_opmode_flag { 5176 STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0), 5177 STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED = BIT(1), 5178 STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED = BIT(2), 5179 }; 5180 5181 /** 5182 * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information 5183 * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag 5184 * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station 5185 * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station 5186 * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station 5187 */ 5188 5189 struct sta_opmode_info { 5190 u32 changed; 5191 enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode; 5192 enum nl80211_chan_width bw; 5193 u8 rx_nss; 5194 }; 5195 5196 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA)) 5197 5198 /** 5199 * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition 5200 * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211 5201 * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags 5202 * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the 5203 * flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data 5204 * pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all 5205 * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The 5206 * @storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple 5207 * dumpit calls. 5208 * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA. 5209 * Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the 5210 * attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command). 5211 * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy 5212 * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and 5213 * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others 5214 * are used with dump requests. 5215 */ 5216 struct wiphy_vendor_command { 5217 struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info; 5218 u32 flags; 5219 int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 5220 const void *data, int data_len); 5221 int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 5222 struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len, 5223 unsigned long *storage); 5224 const struct nla_policy *policy; 5225 unsigned int maxattr; 5226 }; 5227 5228 /** 5229 * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type 5230 * @iftype: interface type 5231 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 5232 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the 5233 * 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are 5234 * in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std 5235 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. 5236 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 5237 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 5238 * @eml_capabilities: EML capabilities (for MLO) 5239 * @mld_capa_and_ops: MLD capabilities and operations (for MLO) 5240 */ 5241 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab { 5242 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 5243 const u8 *extended_capabilities; 5244 const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask; 5245 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 5246 u16 eml_capabilities; 5247 u16 mld_capa_and_ops; 5248 }; 5249 5250 /** 5251 * cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa - lookup interface type extended capability 5252 * @wiphy: the wiphy to look up from 5253 * @type: the interface type to look up 5254 */ 5255 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab * 5256 cfg80211_get_iftype_ext_capa(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype type); 5257 5258 /** 5259 * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities 5260 * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement 5261 * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement 5262 * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement 5263 * @ftm: FTM measurement data 5264 * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported 5265 * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported 5266 * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported 5267 * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data 5268 * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data 5269 * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble) 5270 * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width) 5271 * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported 5272 * (set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily 5273 * forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick) 5274 * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if 5275 * not limited) 5276 * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported 5277 * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported 5278 */ 5279 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities { 5280 unsigned int max_peers; 5281 u8 report_ap_tsf:1, 5282 randomize_mac_addr:1; 5283 5284 struct { 5285 u32 preambles; 5286 u32 bandwidths; 5287 s8 max_bursts_exponent; 5288 u8 max_ftms_per_burst; 5289 u8 supported:1, 5290 asap:1, 5291 non_asap:1, 5292 request_lci:1, 5293 request_civicloc:1, 5294 trigger_based:1, 5295 non_trigger_based:1; 5296 } ftm; 5297 }; 5298 5299 /** 5300 * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm 5301 * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the 5302 * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites. 5303 * 5304 * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types 5305 * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites 5306 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 5307 */ 5308 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites { 5309 u16 iftypes_mask; 5310 const u32 *akm_suites; 5311 int n_akm_suites; 5312 }; 5313 5314 #define CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS 0xffff 5315 5316 /** 5317 * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description 5318 * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device 5319 * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback, 5320 * note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory() 5321 * the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL 5322 * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via 5323 * the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver 5324 * on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future 5325 * regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers. 5326 * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss. 5327 * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites 5328 * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites 5329 * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if 5330 * the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in 5331 * iftype_akm_suites. 5332 * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites 5333 * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type. 5334 * Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot 5335 * overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all 5336 * instances of iftype_akm_suites). 5337 * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm 5338 * suites are specified separately. 5339 * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit) 5340 * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit) 5341 * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold); 5342 * -1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used 5343 * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled 5344 * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in 5345 * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device 5346 * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking, 5347 * set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last 5348 * four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual 5349 * variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with 5350 * interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up. 5351 * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses. 5352 * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer 5353 * to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used 5354 * by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to 5355 * all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle 5356 * the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses. 5357 * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against 5358 * unregister hardware 5359 * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>). 5360 * It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames 5361 * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in 5362 * /sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev() 5363 * (see below). 5364 * @wext: wireless extension handlers 5365 * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter) 5366 * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy, 5367 * must be set by driver 5368 * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not 5369 * list single interface types. 5370 * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array. 5371 * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not 5372 * subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW. 5373 * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags 5374 * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see 5375 * &enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags 5376 * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags. 5377 * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see 5378 * &enum nl80211_ext_feature_index. 5379 * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it, 5380 * this variable determines its size 5381 * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in 5382 * any given scan 5383 * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that 5384 * the device can run concurrently. 5385 * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan 5386 * for in any given scheduled scan 5387 * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle 5388 * when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not 5389 * supported. 5390 * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can 5391 * add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not 5392 * include fixed IEs like supported rates 5393 * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled 5394 * scans 5395 * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number 5396 * of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device. 5397 * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a 5398 * single scan plan supported by the device. 5399 * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single 5400 * scan plan supported by the device. 5401 * @coverage_class: current coverage class 5402 * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting 5403 * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting 5404 * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device 5405 * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary 5406 * wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers 5407 * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device 5408 * 5409 * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or 5410 * transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface 5411 * type 5412 * 5413 * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 5414 * configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 5415 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set. 5416 * 5417 * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be 5418 * configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be 5419 * rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set. 5420 * 5421 * @probe_resp_offload: 5422 * Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading. 5423 * See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid 5424 * when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set. 5425 * 5426 * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation 5427 * may request, if implemented. 5428 * 5429 * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information 5430 * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be 5431 * used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed 5432 * to the suspend() operation instead. 5433 * 5434 * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features. 5435 * @ht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden. 5436 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 5437 * @vht_capa_mod_mask: Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden. 5438 * If null, then none can be over-ridden. 5439 * 5440 * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must 5441 * not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection. 5442 * 5443 * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device 5444 * supports for ACL. 5445 * 5446 * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver, 5447 * additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are 5448 * the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") 5449 * and are in the same format as in the information element. See 5450 * 802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default 5451 * extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified 5452 * for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab. 5453 * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values 5454 * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities 5455 * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type 5456 * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended 5457 * capabilities are specified separately. 5458 * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information 5459 * 5460 * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware 5461 * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands 5462 * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware 5463 * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events 5464 * 5465 * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode 5466 * (including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The 5467 * driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in 5468 * some cases, but may not always reach. 5469 * 5470 * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons 5471 * and probe responses. This value should be set if the driver 5472 * wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means 5473 * infinite. 5474 * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported 5475 * by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the 5476 * attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr. 5477 * 5478 * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a 5479 * bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values. For instance, for 5480 * NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set 5481 * (i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)). 5482 * 5483 * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit 5484 * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit 5485 * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum 5486 * 5487 * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using 5488 * wake_tx_queue 5489 * 5490 * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP 5491 * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not 5492 * HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues. 5493 * @support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect. 5494 * 5495 * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities 5496 * 5497 * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the 5498 * device has 5499 * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 5500 * supported by the driver for each vif 5501 * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations) 5502 * supported by the driver for each peer 5503 * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for 5504 * long/short retry configuration 5505 * 5506 * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for 5507 * configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and 5508 * %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes 5509 * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities 5510 * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure 5511 * 5512 * @mbssid_max_interfaces: maximum number of interfaces supported by the driver 5513 * in a multiple BSSID set. This field must be set to a non-zero value 5514 * by the driver to advertise MBSSID support. 5515 * @ema_max_profile_periodicity: maximum profile periodicity supported by 5516 * the driver. Setting this field to a non-zero value indicates that the 5517 * driver supports enhanced multi-BSSID advertisements (EMA AP). 5518 * @max_num_akm_suites: maximum number of AKM suites allowed for 5519 * configuration through %NL80211_CMD_CONNECT, %NL80211_CMD_ASSOCIATE and 5520 * %NL80211_CMD_START_AP. Set to NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES if not set by 5521 * driver. If set by driver minimum allowed value is 5522 * NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES in order to avoid compatibility issues with 5523 * legacy userspace and maximum allowed value is 5524 * CFG80211_MAX_NUM_AKM_SUITES. 5525 * 5526 * @hw_timestamp_max_peers: maximum number of peers that the driver supports 5527 * enabling HW timestamping for concurrently. Setting this field to a 5528 * non-zero value indicates that the driver supports HW timestamping. 5529 * A value of %CFG80211_HW_TIMESTAMP_ALL_PEERS indicates the driver 5530 * supports enabling HW timestamping for all peers (i.e. no need to 5531 * specify a mac address). 5532 */ 5533 struct wiphy { 5534 struct mutex mtx; 5535 5536 /* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */ 5537 5538 u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN]; 5539 u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN]; 5540 5541 struct mac_address *addresses; 5542 5543 const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes; 5544 5545 const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations; 5546 int n_iface_combinations; 5547 u16 software_iftypes; 5548 5549 u16 n_addresses; 5550 5551 /* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */ 5552 u16 interface_modes; 5553 5554 u16 max_acl_mac_addrs; 5555 5556 u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features; 5557 u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)]; 5558 5559 u32 ap_sme_capa; 5560 5561 enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type; 5562 5563 int bss_priv_size; 5564 u8 max_scan_ssids; 5565 u8 max_sched_scan_reqs; 5566 u8 max_sched_scan_ssids; 5567 u8 max_match_sets; 5568 u16 max_scan_ie_len; 5569 u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len; 5570 u32 max_sched_scan_plans; 5571 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval; 5572 u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations; 5573 5574 int n_cipher_suites; 5575 const u32 *cipher_suites; 5576 5577 int n_akm_suites; 5578 const u32 *akm_suites; 5579 5580 const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites; 5581 unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites; 5582 5583 u8 retry_short; 5584 u8 retry_long; 5585 u32 frag_threshold; 5586 u32 rts_threshold; 5587 u8 coverage_class; 5588 5589 char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN]; 5590 u32 hw_version; 5591 5592 #ifdef CONFIG_PM 5593 const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan; 5594 struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config; 5595 #endif 5596 5597 u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration; 5598 5599 u8 max_num_pmkids; 5600 5601 u32 available_antennas_tx; 5602 u32 available_antennas_rx; 5603 5604 u32 probe_resp_offload; 5605 5606 const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask; 5607 u8 extended_capabilities_len; 5608 5609 const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab; 5610 unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab; 5611 5612 const void *privid; 5613 5614 struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]; 5615 5616 void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5617 struct regulatory_request *request); 5618 5619 /* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */ 5620 5621 const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd; 5622 5623 struct device dev; 5624 5625 bool registered; 5626 5627 struct dentry *debugfsdir; 5628 5629 const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask; 5630 const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask; 5631 5632 struct list_head wdev_list; 5633 5634 possible_net_t _net; 5635 5636 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 5637 const struct iw_handler_def *wext; 5638 #endif 5639 5640 const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce; 5641 5642 const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands; 5643 const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events; 5644 int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events; 5645 5646 u16 max_ap_assoc_sta; 5647 5648 u8 max_num_csa_counters; 5649 5650 u32 bss_select_support; 5651 5652 u8 nan_supported_bands; 5653 5654 u32 txq_limit; 5655 u32 txq_memory_limit; 5656 u32 txq_quantum; 5657 5658 unsigned long tx_queue_len; 5659 5660 u8 support_mbssid:1, 5661 support_only_he_mbssid:1; 5662 5663 const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa; 5664 5665 struct { 5666 u64 peer, vif; 5667 u8 max_retry; 5668 } tid_config_support; 5669 5670 u8 max_data_retry_count; 5671 5672 const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa; 5673 5674 struct rfkill *rfkill; 5675 5676 u8 mbssid_max_interfaces; 5677 u8 ema_max_profile_periodicity; 5678 u16 max_num_akm_suites; 5679 5680 u16 hw_timestamp_max_peers; 5681 5682 char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN); 5683 }; 5684 5685 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5686 { 5687 return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net); 5688 } 5689 5690 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net) 5691 { 5692 write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net); 5693 } 5694 5695 /** 5696 * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy 5697 * 5698 * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return 5699 * Return: The priv of @wiphy. 5700 */ 5701 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5702 { 5703 BUG_ON(!wiphy); 5704 return &wiphy->priv; 5705 } 5706 5707 /** 5708 * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv 5709 * 5710 * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv 5711 * Return: The wiphy of @priv. 5712 */ 5713 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv) 5714 { 5715 BUG_ON(!priv); 5716 return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv); 5717 } 5718 5719 /** 5720 * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy 5721 * 5722 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind 5723 * @dev: The device to parent it to 5724 */ 5725 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev) 5726 { 5727 wiphy->dev.parent = dev; 5728 } 5729 5730 /** 5731 * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer 5732 * 5733 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up 5734 * Return: The dev of @wiphy. 5735 */ 5736 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5737 { 5738 return wiphy->dev.parent; 5739 } 5740 5741 /** 5742 * wiphy_name - get wiphy name 5743 * 5744 * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return 5745 * Return: The name of @wiphy. 5746 */ 5747 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy) 5748 { 5749 return dev_name(&wiphy->dev); 5750 } 5751 5752 /** 5753 * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5754 * 5755 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5756 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5757 * @requested_name: Request a particular name. 5758 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming. 5759 * 5760 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5761 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5762 * 5763 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5764 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5765 */ 5766 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv, 5767 const char *requested_name); 5768 5769 /** 5770 * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211 5771 * 5772 * @ops: The configuration operations for this device 5773 * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate 5774 * 5775 * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it. 5776 * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use. 5777 * 5778 * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be 5779 * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation. 5780 */ 5781 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, 5782 int sizeof_priv) 5783 { 5784 return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL); 5785 } 5786 5787 /** 5788 * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211 5789 * 5790 * @wiphy: The wiphy to register. 5791 * 5792 * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code. 5793 */ 5794 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5795 5796 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */ 5797 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx) 5798 5799 /** 5800 * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking 5801 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on 5802 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing 5803 * 5804 * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock() 5805 * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference(). 5806 */ 5807 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p) \ 5808 rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) 5809 5810 /** 5811 * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx 5812 * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on 5813 * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing 5814 * 5815 * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the 5816 * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates. 5817 */ 5818 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p) \ 5819 rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx)) 5820 5821 /** 5822 * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy 5823 * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from 5824 */ 5825 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5826 5827 /** 5828 * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211 5829 * 5830 * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister. 5831 * 5832 * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv 5833 * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding 5834 * request that is being handled. 5835 */ 5836 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5837 5838 /** 5839 * wiphy_free - free wiphy 5840 * 5841 * @wiphy: The wiphy to free 5842 */ 5843 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy); 5844 5845 /* internal structs */ 5846 struct cfg80211_conn; 5847 struct cfg80211_internal_bss; 5848 struct cfg80211_cached_keys; 5849 struct cfg80211_cqm_config; 5850 5851 /** 5852 * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy 5853 * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock 5854 * 5855 * This is needed around registering and unregistering netdevs that 5856 * aren't created through cfg80211 calls, since that requires locking 5857 * in cfg80211 when the notifiers is called, but that cannot 5858 * differentiate which way it's called. 5859 * 5860 * It can also be used by drivers for their own purposes. 5861 * 5862 * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked. 5863 * 5864 * Note that this makes sure that no workers that have been queued 5865 * with wiphy_queue_work() are running. 5866 */ 5867 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5868 __acquires(&wiphy->mtx) 5869 { 5870 mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx); 5871 __acquire(&wiphy->mtx); 5872 } 5873 5874 /** 5875 * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again 5876 * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock 5877 */ 5878 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy) 5879 __releases(&wiphy->mtx) 5880 { 5881 __release(&wiphy->mtx); 5882 mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx); 5883 } 5884 5885 struct wiphy_work; 5886 typedef void (*wiphy_work_func_t)(struct wiphy *, struct wiphy_work *); 5887 5888 struct wiphy_work { 5889 struct list_head entry; 5890 wiphy_work_func_t func; 5891 }; 5892 5893 static inline void wiphy_work_init(struct wiphy_work *work, 5894 wiphy_work_func_t func) 5895 { 5896 INIT_LIST_HEAD(&work->entry); 5897 work->func = func; 5898 } 5899 5900 /** 5901 * wiphy_work_queue - queue work for the wiphy 5902 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for 5903 * @work: the work item 5904 * 5905 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work 5906 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be 5907 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running 5908 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can 5909 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires 5910 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock(). 5911 */ 5912 void wiphy_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work); 5913 5914 /** 5915 * wiphy_work_cancel - cancel previously queued work 5916 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes 5917 * @work: the work to cancel 5918 * 5919 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being 5920 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). 5921 */ 5922 void wiphy_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work); 5923 5924 /** 5925 * wiphy_work_flush - flush previously queued work 5926 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes 5927 * @work: the work to flush, this can be %NULL to flush all work 5928 * 5929 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called 5930 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). 5931 */ 5932 void wiphy_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wiphy_work *work); 5933 5934 struct wiphy_delayed_work { 5935 struct wiphy_work work; 5936 struct wiphy *wiphy; 5937 struct timer_list timer; 5938 }; 5939 5940 void wiphy_delayed_work_timer(struct timer_list *t); 5941 5942 static inline void wiphy_delayed_work_init(struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork, 5943 wiphy_work_func_t func) 5944 { 5945 timer_setup(&dwork->timer, wiphy_delayed_work_timer, 0); 5946 wiphy_work_init(&dwork->work, func); 5947 } 5948 5949 /** 5950 * wiphy_delayed_work_queue - queue delayed work for the wiphy 5951 * @wiphy: the wiphy to queue for 5952 * @dwork: the delayable worker 5953 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing 5954 * 5955 * This is useful for work that must be done asynchronously, and work 5956 * queued here has the special property that the wiphy mutex will be 5957 * held as if wiphy_lock() was called, and that it cannot be running 5958 * after wiphy_lock() was called. Therefore, wiphy_cancel_work() can 5959 * use just cancel_work() instead of cancel_work_sync(), it requires 5960 * being in a section protected by wiphy_lock(). 5961 */ 5962 void wiphy_delayed_work_queue(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5963 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork, 5964 unsigned long delay); 5965 5966 /** 5967 * wiphy_delayed_work_cancel - cancel previously queued delayed work 5968 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes 5969 * @dwork: the delayed work to cancel 5970 * 5971 * Cancel the work *without* waiting for it, this assumes being 5972 * called under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). 5973 */ 5974 void wiphy_delayed_work_cancel(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5975 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork); 5976 5977 /** 5978 * wiphy_delayed_work_flush - flush previously queued delayed work 5979 * @wiphy: the wiphy, for debug purposes 5980 * @dwork: the delayed work to flush 5981 * 5982 * Flush the work (i.e. run it if pending). This must be called 5983 * under the wiphy mutex acquired by wiphy_lock(). 5984 */ 5985 void wiphy_delayed_work_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy, 5986 struct wiphy_delayed_work *dwork); 5987 5988 /** 5989 * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state 5990 * 5991 * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver 5992 * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this 5993 * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.) 5994 * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will 5995 * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device, 5996 * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or 5997 * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops 5998 * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.) 5999 * 6000 * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver 6001 * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as 6002 * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be 6003 * allocated outside of callback operations that return it. 6004 * 6005 * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description 6006 * @iftype: interface type 6007 * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211 6008 * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock 6009 * for the notifier 6010 * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces 6011 * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL 6012 * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this 6013 * wireless device if it has no netdev 6014 * @u: union containing data specific to @iftype 6015 * @connected: indicates if connected or not (STA mode) 6016 * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code 6017 * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code 6018 * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling 6019 * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data 6020 * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data 6021 * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association 6022 * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements 6023 * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID 6024 * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID 6025 * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index 6026 * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index 6027 * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation 6028 * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity 6029 * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be 6030 * set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the 6031 * netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update 6032 * by cfg80211 on change_interface 6033 * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames 6034 * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated, 6035 * need to propagate the update to the driver 6036 * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting 6037 * beacons, 0 when not valid 6038 * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL 6039 * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g. 6040 * the P2P Device. 6041 * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started 6042 * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered. 6043 * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms 6044 * @ps: powersave mode is enabled 6045 * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout 6046 * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application 6047 * registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode) 6048 * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data 6049 * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established 6050 * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type 6051 * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID 6052 * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work 6053 * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect 6054 * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing 6055 * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list 6056 * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID 6057 * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away 6058 * @cqm_rssi_work: (private) CQM RSSI reporting work 6059 * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state 6060 * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests 6061 * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock 6062 * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work 6063 * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last 6064 * unprotected beacon report 6065 * @links: array of %IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS elements containing @addr 6066 * @ap and @client for each link 6067 * @valid_links: bitmap describing what elements of @links are valid 6068 */ 6069 struct wireless_dev { 6070 struct wiphy *wiphy; 6071 enum nl80211_iftype iftype; 6072 6073 /* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */ 6074 struct list_head list; 6075 struct net_device *netdev; 6076 6077 u32 identifier; 6078 6079 struct list_head mgmt_registrations; 6080 u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1; 6081 6082 bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering; 6083 6084 u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16)); 6085 6086 /* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */ 6087 struct cfg80211_conn *conn; 6088 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys; 6089 enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type; 6090 u32 conn_owner_nlportid; 6091 6092 struct work_struct disconnect_wk; 6093 u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 6094 6095 struct list_head event_list; 6096 spinlock_t event_lock; 6097 6098 u8 connected:1; 6099 6100 bool ps; 6101 int ps_timeout; 6102 6103 u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid; 6104 6105 u32 owner_nlportid; 6106 bool nl_owner_dead; 6107 6108 /* FIXME: need to rework radar detection for MLO */ 6109 bool cac_started; 6110 unsigned long cac_start_time; 6111 unsigned int cac_time_ms; 6112 6113 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT 6114 /* wext data */ 6115 struct { 6116 struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss; 6117 struct cfg80211_connect_params connect; 6118 struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys; 6119 const u8 *ie; 6120 size_t ie_len; 6121 u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 6122 u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN]; 6123 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 6124 s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key; 6125 bool prev_bssid_valid; 6126 } wext; 6127 #endif 6128 6129 struct wiphy_work cqm_rssi_work; 6130 struct cfg80211_cqm_config __rcu *cqm_config; 6131 6132 struct list_head pmsr_list; 6133 spinlock_t pmsr_lock; 6134 struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk; 6135 6136 unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported; 6137 6138 union { 6139 struct { 6140 u8 connected_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 6141 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 6142 u8 ssid_len; 6143 } client; 6144 struct { 6145 int beacon_interval; 6146 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; 6147 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 6148 u8 id[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 6149 u8 id_len, id_up_len; 6150 } mesh; 6151 struct { 6152 struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef; 6153 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 6154 u8 ssid_len; 6155 } ap; 6156 struct { 6157 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; 6158 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 6159 int beacon_interval; 6160 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN]; 6161 u8 ssid_len; 6162 } ibss; 6163 struct { 6164 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 6165 } ocb; 6166 } u; 6167 6168 struct { 6169 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 6170 union { 6171 struct { 6172 unsigned int beacon_interval; 6173 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef; 6174 } ap; 6175 struct { 6176 struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; 6177 } client; 6178 }; 6179 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 6180 u16 valid_links; 6181 }; 6182 6183 static inline const u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 6184 { 6185 if (wdev->netdev) 6186 return wdev->netdev->dev_addr; 6187 return wdev->address; 6188 } 6189 6190 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 6191 { 6192 if (wdev->netdev) 6193 return netif_running(wdev->netdev); 6194 return wdev->is_running; 6195 } 6196 6197 /** 6198 * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev 6199 * 6200 * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return 6201 * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev. 6202 */ 6203 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev) 6204 { 6205 BUG_ON(!wdev); 6206 return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy); 6207 } 6208 6209 /** 6210 * wdev_chandef - return chandef pointer from wireless_dev 6211 * @wdev: the wdev 6212 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO 6213 * 6214 * Return: The chandef depending on the mode, or %NULL. 6215 */ 6216 struct cfg80211_chan_def *wdev_chandef(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6217 unsigned int link_id); 6218 6219 static inline void WARN_INVALID_LINK_ID(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 6220 unsigned int link_id) 6221 { 6222 WARN_ON(link_id && !wdev->valid_links); 6223 WARN_ON(wdev->valid_links && 6224 !(wdev->valid_links & BIT(link_id))); 6225 } 6226 6227 #define for_each_valid_link(link_info, link_id) \ 6228 for (link_id = 0; \ 6229 link_id < ((link_info)->valid_links ? \ 6230 ARRAY_SIZE((link_info)->links) : 1); \ 6231 link_id++) \ 6232 if (!(link_info)->valid_links || \ 6233 ((link_info)->valid_links & BIT(link_id))) 6234 6235 /** 6236 * DOC: Utility functions 6237 * 6238 * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful. 6239 */ 6240 6241 /** 6242 * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel 6243 * 6244 * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel 6245 * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel 6246 * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b 6247 */ 6248 static inline bool 6249 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a, 6250 struct ieee80211_channel *b) 6251 { 6252 return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq && 6253 a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset); 6254 } 6255 6256 /** 6257 * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz 6258 * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert 6259 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz) 6260 */ 6261 static inline u32 6262 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 6263 { 6264 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset; 6265 } 6266 6267 /** 6268 * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan 6269 * 6270 * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ 6271 * @chan: channel 6272 * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq 6273 */ 6274 enum nl80211_chan_width 6275 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan); 6276 6277 /** 6278 * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency 6279 * @chan: channel number 6280 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 6281 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 6282 */ 6283 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band); 6284 6285 /** 6286 * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency 6287 * @chan: channel number 6288 * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap 6289 * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed. 6290 */ 6291 static inline int 6292 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band) 6293 { 6294 return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band)); 6295 } 6296 6297 /** 6298 * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 6299 * @freq: center frequency in KHz 6300 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 6301 */ 6302 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq); 6303 6304 /** 6305 * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number 6306 * @freq: center frequency in MHz 6307 * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed. 6308 */ 6309 static inline int 6310 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq) 6311 { 6312 return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 6313 } 6314 6315 /** 6316 * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified 6317 * frequency 6318 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 6319 * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel 6320 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 6321 */ 6322 struct ieee80211_channel * 6323 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq); 6324 6325 /** 6326 * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency 6327 * 6328 * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for 6329 * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel 6330 * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq. 6331 */ 6332 static inline struct ieee80211_channel * 6333 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq) 6334 { 6335 return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq)); 6336 } 6337 6338 /** 6339 * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC 6340 * @chan: control channel to check 6341 * 6342 * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in 6343 * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3 6344 */ 6345 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan) 6346 { 6347 if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ) 6348 return false; 6349 6350 return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5; 6351 } 6352 6353 /** 6354 * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate 6355 * 6356 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 6357 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates 6358 * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate 6359 * 6360 * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that 6361 * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map, 6362 * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of 6363 * rates in the band's bitrate table. 6364 */ 6365 const struct ieee80211_rate * 6366 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband, 6367 u32 basic_rates, int bitrate); 6368 6369 /** 6370 * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band 6371 * @sband: the band to look for rates in 6372 * 6373 * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given 6374 * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array. 6375 */ 6376 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband); 6377 6378 /* 6379 * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support 6380 * 6381 * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c 6382 * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst 6383 */ 6384 6385 struct radiotap_align_size { 6386 uint8_t align:4, size:4; 6387 }; 6388 6389 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace { 6390 const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size; 6391 int n_bits; 6392 uint32_t oui; 6393 uint8_t subns; 6394 }; 6395 6396 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces { 6397 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns; 6398 int n_ns; 6399 }; 6400 6401 /** 6402 * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args 6403 * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call 6404 * to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() 6405 * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each 6406 * call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after 6407 * ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to 6408 * the beginning of the actual data portion 6409 * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience 6410 * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition 6411 * (or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown) 6412 * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default 6413 * radiotap namespace or not 6414 * 6415 * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through 6416 * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering 6417 * @_arg_index: next argument index 6418 * @_arg: next argument pointer 6419 * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32 6420 * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present 6421 * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions 6422 * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data 6423 * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the 6424 * next bitmap word 6425 * 6426 * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore 6427 * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally. 6428 */ 6429 6430 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator { 6431 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader; 6432 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns; 6433 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace; 6434 6435 unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data; 6436 __le32 *_next_bitmap; 6437 6438 unsigned char *this_arg; 6439 int this_arg_index; 6440 int this_arg_size; 6441 6442 int is_radiotap_ns; 6443 6444 int _max_length; 6445 int _arg_index; 6446 uint32_t _bitmap_shifter; 6447 int _reset_on_ext; 6448 }; 6449 6450 int 6451 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator, 6452 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header, 6453 int max_length, 6454 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns); 6455 6456 int 6457 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator); 6458 6459 6460 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6]; 6461 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6]; 6462 6463 /** 6464 * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data 6465 * 6466 * @skb: the frame 6467 * 6468 * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function 6469 * returns the 802.11 header length. 6470 * 6471 * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption 6472 * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid 6473 * 802.11 header. 6474 */ 6475 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb); 6476 6477 /** 6478 * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control 6479 * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format 6480 * Return: The header length in bytes. 6481 */ 6482 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc); 6483 6484 /** 6485 * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length 6486 * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field 6487 * (first byte) will be accessed 6488 * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at 6489 * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present. 6490 */ 6491 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr); 6492 6493 /** 6494 * DOC: Data path helpers 6495 * 6496 * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers 6497 * functions that help implement the data path for devices 6498 * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device. 6499 */ 6500 6501 /** 6502 * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 6503 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 6504 * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead 6505 * of it being pushed into the SKB 6506 * @addr: the device MAC address 6507 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 6508 * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header 6509 * @is_amsdu: true if the 802.11 header is A-MSDU 6510 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 6511 */ 6512 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr, 6513 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 6514 u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu); 6515 6516 /** 6517 * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3 6518 * @skb: the 802.11 data frame 6519 * @addr: the device MAC address 6520 * @iftype: the virtual interface type 6521 * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error. 6522 */ 6523 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr, 6524 enum nl80211_iftype iftype) 6525 { 6526 return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false); 6527 } 6528 6529 /** 6530 * ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu - check if subframe lengths of an A-MSDU are valid 6531 * 6532 * This is used to detect non-standard A-MSDU frames, e.g. the ones generated 6533 * by ath10k and ath11k, where the subframe length includes the length of the 6534 * mesh control field. 6535 * 6536 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. 6537 * @mesh_hdr: the type of mesh header to test 6538 * 0: non-mesh A-MSDU length field 6539 * 1: big-endian mesh A-MSDU length field 6540 * 2: little-endian mesh A-MSDU length field 6541 * Returns: true if subframe header lengths are valid for the @mesh_hdr mode 6542 */ 6543 bool ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 mesh_hdr); 6544 6545 /** 6546 * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame 6547 * 6548 * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames. 6549 * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully 6550 * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function. 6551 * 6552 * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers. 6553 * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and 6554 * initialized by the caller. 6555 * @addr: The device MAC address. 6556 * @iftype: The device interface type. 6557 * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list. 6558 * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 6559 * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL 6560 * @mesh_control: see mesh_hdr in ieee80211_is_valid_amsdu 6561 */ 6562 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list, 6563 const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 6564 const unsigned int extra_headroom, 6565 const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa, 6566 u8 mesh_control); 6567 6568 /** 6569 * ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto - get RFC1042 or bridge tunnel encap protocol 6570 * 6571 * Check for RFC1042 or bridge tunnel header and fetch the encapsulated 6572 * protocol. 6573 * 6574 * @hdr: pointer to the MSDU payload 6575 * @proto: destination pointer to store the protocol 6576 * Return: true if encapsulation was found 6577 */ 6578 bool ieee80211_get_8023_tunnel_proto(const void *hdr, __be16 *proto); 6579 6580 /** 6581 * ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr - strip mesh header from converted 802.3 frames 6582 * 6583 * Strip the mesh header, which was left in by ieee80211_data_to_8023 as part 6584 * of the MSDU data. Also move any source/destination addresses from the mesh 6585 * header to the ethernet header (if present). 6586 * 6587 * @skb: The 802.3 frame with embedded mesh header 6588 */ 6589 int ieee80211_strip_8023_mesh_hdr(struct sk_buff *skb); 6590 6591 /** 6592 * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame 6593 * @skb: the data frame 6594 * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use 6595 * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag. 6596 */ 6597 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb, 6598 struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map); 6599 6600 /** 6601 * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data 6602 * 6603 * @eid: element ID 6604 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6605 * @len: length of data 6606 * @match: byte array to match 6607 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 6608 * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match. 6609 * Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers 6610 * the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take 6611 * the data portion instead. 6612 * 6613 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 6614 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6615 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 6616 * requested element struct. 6617 * 6618 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6619 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 6620 * byte array to match. 6621 */ 6622 const struct element * 6623 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 6624 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 6625 unsigned int match_offset); 6626 6627 /** 6628 * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data 6629 * 6630 * @eid: element ID 6631 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6632 * @len: length of data 6633 * @match: byte array to match 6634 * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array 6635 * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match. 6636 * If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero. 6637 * Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first 6638 * byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and 6639 * the second byte is the IE length. 6640 * 6641 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 6642 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6643 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first 6644 * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 6645 * element ID. 6646 * 6647 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6648 * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the 6649 * byte array to match. 6650 */ 6651 static inline const u8 * 6652 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 6653 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len, 6654 unsigned int match_offset) 6655 { 6656 /* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is 6657 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well. 6658 */ 6659 if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) || 6660 (!match_len && match_offset))) 6661 return NULL; 6662 6663 return (const void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, 6664 match, match_len, 6665 match_offset ? 6666 match_offset - 2 : 0); 6667 } 6668 6669 /** 6670 * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data 6671 * 6672 * @eid: element ID 6673 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6674 * @len: length of data 6675 * 6676 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 6677 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6678 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 6679 * requested element struct. 6680 * 6681 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6682 * having to fit into the given data. 6683 */ 6684 static inline const struct element * 6685 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 6686 { 6687 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 6688 } 6689 6690 /** 6691 * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data 6692 * 6693 * @eid: element ID 6694 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6695 * @len: length of data 6696 * 6697 * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if 6698 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6699 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 6700 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 6701 * 6702 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6703 * having to fit into the given data. 6704 */ 6705 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 6706 { 6707 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0); 6708 } 6709 6710 /** 6711 * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data 6712 * 6713 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 6714 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6715 * @len: length of data 6716 * 6717 * Return: %NULL if the extended element could not be found or if 6718 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6719 * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the 6720 * requested element struct. 6721 * 6722 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6723 * having to fit into the given data. 6724 */ 6725 static inline const struct element * 6726 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 6727 { 6728 return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 6729 &ext_eid, 1, 0); 6730 } 6731 6732 /** 6733 * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data 6734 * 6735 * @ext_eid: element ID Extension 6736 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6737 * @len: length of data 6738 * 6739 * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if 6740 * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given 6741 * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested 6742 * element, that is the byte containing the element ID. 6743 * 6744 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than 6745 * having to fit into the given data. 6746 */ 6747 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len) 6748 { 6749 return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len, 6750 &ext_eid, 1, 2); 6751 } 6752 6753 /** 6754 * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data 6755 * 6756 * @oui: vendor OUI 6757 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 6758 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6759 * @len: length of data 6760 * 6761 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 6762 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise 6763 * return the element structure for the requested element. 6764 * 6765 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 6766 * the given data. 6767 */ 6768 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 6769 const u8 *ies, 6770 unsigned int len); 6771 6772 /** 6773 * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data 6774 * 6775 * @oui: vendor OUI 6776 * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any 6777 * @ies: data consisting of IEs 6778 * @len: length of data 6779 * 6780 * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the 6781 * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to 6782 * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the 6783 * element ID. 6784 * 6785 * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into 6786 * the given data. 6787 */ 6788 static inline const u8 * 6789 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type, 6790 const u8 *ies, unsigned int len) 6791 { 6792 return (const void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len); 6793 } 6794 6795 /** 6796 * cfg80211_defragment_element - Defrag the given element data into a buffer 6797 * 6798 * @elem: the element to defragment 6799 * @ies: elements where @elem is contained 6800 * @ieslen: length of @ies 6801 * @data: buffer to store element data 6802 * @data_len: length of @data 6803 * @frag_id: the element ID of fragments 6804 * 6805 * Return: length of @data, or -EINVAL on error 6806 * 6807 * Copy out all data from an element that may be fragmented into @data, while 6808 * skipping all headers. 6809 * 6810 * The function uses memmove() internally. It is acceptable to defragment an 6811 * element in-place. 6812 */ 6813 ssize_t cfg80211_defragment_element(const struct element *elem, const u8 *ies, 6814 size_t ieslen, u8 *data, size_t data_len, 6815 u8 frag_id); 6816 6817 /** 6818 * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame 6819 * 6820 * @dev: network device 6821 * @addr: STA MAC address 6822 * 6823 * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge 6824 * devices upon STA association. 6825 */ 6826 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 6827 6828 /** 6829 * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure 6830 * 6831 * TODO 6832 */ 6833 6834 /** 6835 * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain 6836 * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting 6837 * conflicts) 6838 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain 6839 * should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you 6840 * set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted 6841 * alpha2. 6842 * 6843 * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core 6844 * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by 6845 * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory 6846 * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain. 6847 * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried 6848 * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country. 6849 * 6850 * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call. 6851 * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(), 6852 * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw(). 6853 * 6854 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 6855 * an -ENOMEM. 6856 * 6857 * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM. 6858 */ 6859 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2); 6860 6861 /** 6862 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers 6863 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6864 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy 6865 * 6866 * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they 6867 * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more 6868 * information. 6869 * 6870 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 6871 */ 6872 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6873 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 6874 6875 /** 6876 * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers 6877 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6878 * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy 6879 * 6880 * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and 6881 * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details 6882 * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(). 6883 * 6884 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM 6885 */ 6886 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6887 struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd); 6888 6889 /** 6890 * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain 6891 * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on 6892 * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy 6893 * 6894 * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply 6895 * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory 6896 * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The 6897 * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous 6898 * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a 6899 * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled. 6900 * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag 6901 * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy 6902 * that called this helper. 6903 */ 6904 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6905 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd); 6906 6907 /** 6908 * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency 6909 * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for 6910 * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for 6911 * 6912 * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on 6913 * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain 6914 * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received 6915 * and processed already. 6916 * 6917 * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule 6918 * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to 6919 * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return 6920 * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even 6921 * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band. 6922 * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is 6923 * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific. 6924 */ 6925 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy, 6926 u32 center_freq); 6927 6928 /** 6929 * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name 6930 * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator 6931 * 6932 * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a 6933 * proper string representation. 6934 */ 6935 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator); 6936 6937 /** 6938 * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom 6939 * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked. 6940 * 6941 * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI). 6942 */ 6943 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy); 6944 6945 /** 6946 * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions 6947 * 6948 */ 6949 6950 /** 6951 * reg_query_regdb_wmm - Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule 6952 * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively 6953 * 6954 * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried. 6955 * @freq: the frequency (in MHz) to be queried. 6956 * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db. 6957 * 6958 * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to query 6959 * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given 6960 * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations. 6961 * 6962 * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get 6963 * an -ENODATA. 6964 * 6965 * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA. 6966 */ 6967 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq, 6968 struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule); 6969 6970 /* 6971 * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification 6972 * functions and BSS handling helpers 6973 */ 6974 6975 /** 6976 * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished 6977 * 6978 * @request: the corresponding scan request 6979 * @info: information about the completed scan 6980 */ 6981 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request, 6982 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info); 6983 6984 /** 6985 * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available 6986 * 6987 * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results 6988 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6989 */ 6990 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 6991 6992 /** 6993 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 6994 * 6995 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 6996 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 6997 * 6998 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 6999 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 7000 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 7001 */ 7002 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 7003 7004 /** 7005 * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped 7006 * 7007 * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped 7008 * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request 7009 * 7010 * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the 7011 * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason. The driver 7012 * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done. 7013 * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held. 7014 */ 7015 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid); 7016 7017 /** 7018 * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame 7019 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 7020 * @data: the BSS metadata 7021 * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon) 7022 * @len: length of the management frame 7023 * @gfp: context flags 7024 * 7025 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 7026 * the BSS should be updated/added. 7027 * 7028 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 7029 * Or %NULL on error. 7030 */ 7031 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 7032 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7033 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 7034 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 7035 gfp_t gfp); 7036 7037 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 7038 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7039 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 7040 struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len, 7041 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 7042 { 7043 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 7044 .chan = rx_channel, 7045 .signal = signal, 7046 }; 7047 7048 return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp); 7049 } 7050 7051 /** 7052 * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID 7053 * @bssid: transmitter BSSID 7054 * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element 7055 * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element 7056 * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID 7057 */ 7058 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid, 7059 u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid) 7060 { 7061 u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid); 7062 u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0); 7063 u64 new_bssid_u64; 7064 7065 new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask; 7066 7067 new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask; 7068 7069 u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid); 7070 } 7071 7072 /** 7073 * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited 7074 * @element: element to check 7075 * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element 7076 */ 7077 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element, 7078 const struct element *non_inherit_element); 7079 7080 /** 7081 * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs 7082 * @ie: ies 7083 * @ielen: length of IEs 7084 * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element 7085 * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile) 7086 * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile 7087 * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length 7088 */ 7089 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 7090 const struct element *mbssid_elem, 7091 const struct element *sub_elem, 7092 u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len); 7093 7094 /** 7095 * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from 7096 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is 7097 * from a beacon or probe response 7098 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon 7099 * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response 7100 */ 7101 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type { 7102 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN, 7103 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON, 7104 CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP, 7105 }; 7106 7107 /** 7108 * cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number - returns the channel number from ies 7109 * @ie: IEs 7110 * @ielen: length of IEs 7111 * @band: enum nl80211_band of the channel 7112 * 7113 * Returns the channel number, or -1 if none could be determined. 7114 */ 7115 int cfg80211_get_ies_channel_number(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 7116 enum nl80211_band band); 7117 7118 /** 7119 * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS 7120 * 7121 * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS 7122 * @data: the BSS metadata 7123 * @ftype: frame type (if known) 7124 * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS 7125 * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0) 7126 * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer 7127 * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer 7128 * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer 7129 * @ielen: length of the additional IEs 7130 * @gfp: context flags 7131 * 7132 * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and 7133 * the BSS should be updated/added. 7134 * 7135 * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()! 7136 * Or %NULL on error. 7137 */ 7138 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 7139 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7140 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data, 7141 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 7142 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 7143 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 7144 gfp_t gfp); 7145 7146 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check 7147 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7148 struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel, 7149 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype, 7150 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability, 7151 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen, 7152 s32 signal, gfp_t gfp) 7153 { 7154 struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = { 7155 .chan = rx_channel, 7156 .signal = signal, 7157 }; 7158 7159 return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf, 7160 capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen, 7161 gfp); 7162 } 7163 7164 /** 7165 * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference 7166 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 7167 * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL) 7168 * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL) 7169 * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL) 7170 * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0) 7171 * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type 7172 * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy 7173 */ 7174 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7175 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 7176 const u8 *bssid, 7177 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len, 7178 enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type, 7179 enum ieee80211_privacy privacy); 7180 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * 7181 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7182 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, 7183 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len) 7184 { 7185 return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len, 7186 IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS, 7187 IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY); 7188 } 7189 7190 /** 7191 * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct 7192 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 7193 * @bss: the BSS struct to reference 7194 * 7195 * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct. 7196 */ 7197 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 7198 7199 /** 7200 * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct 7201 * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to 7202 * @bss: the BSS struct 7203 * 7204 * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct. 7205 */ 7206 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 7207 7208 /** 7209 * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures 7210 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7211 * @bss: the bss to remove 7212 * 7213 * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures 7214 * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this 7215 * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time 7216 * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all. 7217 */ 7218 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss); 7219 7220 /** 7221 * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries 7222 * 7223 * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy 7224 * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not 7225 * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB. 7226 * 7227 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7228 * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel 7229 * of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel. 7230 * @iter: the iterator function to call 7231 * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function 7232 */ 7233 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7234 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 7235 void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7236 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, 7237 void *data), 7238 void *iter_data); 7239 7240 /** 7241 * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame 7242 * @dev: network device 7243 * @buf: authentication frame (header + body) 7244 * @len: length of the frame data 7245 * 7246 * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or 7247 * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode. 7248 * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must 7249 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 7250 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 7251 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 7252 * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed 7253 * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used 7254 * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function 7255 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead. 7256 * 7257 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 7258 */ 7259 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len); 7260 7261 /** 7262 * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication 7263 * @dev: network device 7264 * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out 7265 * 7266 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's 7267 * mutex. 7268 */ 7269 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr); 7270 7271 /** 7272 * struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data - association response data 7273 * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer 7274 * moves to cfg80211 in the call to cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp() 7275 * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body) 7276 * @len: length of the frame data 7277 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format 7278 * as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field 7279 * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame 7280 * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data 7281 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address (in case of MLO) 7282 * @links: per-link information indexed by link ID, use links[0] for 7283 * non-MLO connections 7284 * @links.status: Set this (along with a BSS pointer) for links that 7285 * were rejected by the AP. 7286 */ 7287 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data { 7288 const u8 *buf; 7289 size_t len; 7290 const u8 *req_ies; 7291 size_t req_ies_len; 7292 int uapsd_queues; 7293 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 7294 struct { 7295 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2); 7296 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 7297 u16 status; 7298 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 7299 }; 7300 7301 /** 7302 * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response 7303 * @dev: network device 7304 * @data: association response data, &struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data 7305 * 7306 * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must 7307 * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout(). 7308 * 7309 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 7310 */ 7311 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev, 7312 struct cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp_data *data); 7313 7314 /** 7315 * struct cfg80211_assoc_failure - association failure data 7316 * @ap_mld_addr: AP MLD address, or %NULL 7317 * @bss: list of BSSes, must use entry 0 for non-MLO connections 7318 * (@ap_mld_addr is %NULL) 7319 * @timeout: indicates the association failed due to timeout, otherwise 7320 * the association was abandoned for a reason reported through some 7321 * other API (e.g. deauth RX) 7322 */ 7323 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure { 7324 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 7325 struct cfg80211_bss *bss[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 7326 bool timeout; 7327 }; 7328 7329 /** 7330 * cfg80211_assoc_failure - notification of association failure 7331 * @dev: network device 7332 * @data: data describing the association failure 7333 * 7334 * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 7335 */ 7336 void cfg80211_assoc_failure(struct net_device *dev, 7337 struct cfg80211_assoc_failure *data); 7338 7339 /** 7340 * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame 7341 * @dev: network device 7342 * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body) 7343 * @len: length of the frame data 7344 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute) 7345 * 7346 * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in 7347 * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and 7348 * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the 7349 * corresponding wdev's mutex. 7350 */ 7351 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 7352 bool reconnect); 7353 7354 /** 7355 * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame 7356 * @dev: network device 7357 * @buf: received management frame (header + body) 7358 * @len: length of the frame data 7359 * 7360 * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc 7361 * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the 7362 * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon 7363 * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while 7364 * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode). 7365 * 7366 * This function may sleep. 7367 */ 7368 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, 7369 const u8 *buf, size_t len); 7370 7371 /** 7372 * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP) 7373 * @dev: network device 7374 * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame 7375 * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used 7376 * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing. 7377 * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets) 7378 * @gfp: allocation flags 7379 * 7380 * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a 7381 * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication() 7382 * primitive. 7383 */ 7384 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 7385 enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id, 7386 const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp); 7387 7388 /** 7389 * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS 7390 * 7391 * @dev: network device 7392 * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined 7393 * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined 7394 * @gfp: allocation flags 7395 * 7396 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or 7397 * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called, 7398 * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of 7399 * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called 7400 * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is 7401 * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest. 7402 */ 7403 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7404 struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp); 7405 7406 /** 7407 * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer 7408 * candidate 7409 * 7410 * @dev: network device 7411 * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate 7412 * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate 7413 * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer 7414 * @sig_dbm: signal level in dBm 7415 * @gfp: allocation flags 7416 * 7417 * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been 7418 * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response. 7419 * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace. 7420 */ 7421 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev, 7422 const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len, 7423 int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp); 7424 7425 /** 7426 * DOC: RFkill integration 7427 * 7428 * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers, 7429 * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each 7430 * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated 7431 * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are 7432 * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down. 7433 * 7434 * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they 7435 * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211. 7436 * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here. 7437 */ 7438 7439 /** 7440 * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state 7441 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7442 * @blocked: block status 7443 * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons 7444 */ 7445 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked, 7446 enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason); 7447 7448 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked) 7449 { 7450 wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked, 7451 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL); 7452 } 7453 7454 /** 7455 * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill 7456 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7457 */ 7458 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7459 7460 /** 7461 * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill 7462 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7463 */ 7464 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy) 7465 { 7466 rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill); 7467 } 7468 7469 /** 7470 * DOC: Vendor commands 7471 * 7472 * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that 7473 * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the 7474 * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with 7475 * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as 7476 * the configuration mechanism. 7477 * 7478 * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array 7479 * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an 7480 * OUI and sub command ID to identify it. 7481 * 7482 * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol 7483 * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular, 7484 * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any 7485 * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection 7486 * managers etc. need. 7487 */ 7488 7489 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7490 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 7491 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 7492 int approxlen); 7493 7494 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7495 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7496 enum nl80211_commands cmd, 7497 enum nl80211_attrs attr, 7498 unsigned int portid, 7499 int vendor_event_idx, 7500 int approxlen, gfp_t gfp); 7501 7502 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp); 7503 7504 /** 7505 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply 7506 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7507 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 7508 * be put into the skb 7509 * 7510 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 7511 * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 7512 * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid. 7513 * 7514 * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in 7515 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 7516 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 7517 * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 7518 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 7519 * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute. 7520 * You must not modify the skb in any other way. 7521 * 7522 * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return 7523 * its error code as the result of the doit() operation. 7524 * 7525 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 7526 */ 7527 static inline struct sk_buff * 7528 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 7529 { 7530 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 7531 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen); 7532 } 7533 7534 /** 7535 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb 7536 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 7537 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb() 7538 * 7539 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 7540 * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should 7541 * return the error code. Note that this function consumes the 7542 * skb regardless of the return value. 7543 * 7544 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 7545 */ 7546 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb); 7547 7548 /** 7549 * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID 7550 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7551 * 7552 * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler. 7553 * Valid to call only there. 7554 */ 7555 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy); 7556 7557 /** 7558 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb 7559 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7560 * @wdev: the wireless device 7561 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 7562 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 7563 * be put into the skb 7564 * @gfp: allocation flags 7565 * 7566 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 7567 * vendor-specific multicast group. 7568 * 7569 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 7570 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 7571 * attribute. 7572 * 7573 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 7574 * skb to send the event. 7575 * 7576 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 7577 */ 7578 static inline struct sk_buff * 7579 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7580 int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 7581 { 7582 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 7583 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 7584 0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 7585 } 7586 7587 /** 7588 * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb 7589 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7590 * @wdev: the wireless device 7591 * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events 7592 * @portid: port ID of the receiver 7593 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 7594 * be put into the skb 7595 * @gfp: allocation flags 7596 * 7597 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to 7598 * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been 7599 * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take 7600 * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes. 7601 * 7602 * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified 7603 * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data 7604 * attribute. 7605 * 7606 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the 7607 * skb to send the event. 7608 * 7609 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 7610 */ 7611 static inline struct sk_buff * 7612 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy, 7613 struct wireless_dev *wdev, 7614 unsigned int portid, int approxlen, 7615 int event_idx, gfp_t gfp) 7616 { 7617 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR, 7618 NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, 7619 portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp); 7620 } 7621 7622 /** 7623 * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event 7624 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc() 7625 * @gfp: allocation flags 7626 * 7627 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 7628 * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it. 7629 */ 7630 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 7631 { 7632 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 7633 } 7634 7635 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE 7636 /** 7637 * DOC: Test mode 7638 * 7639 * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to 7640 * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance, 7641 * factory programming. 7642 * 7643 * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more 7644 * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it. 7645 */ 7646 7647 /** 7648 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply 7649 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7650 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 7651 * be put into the skb 7652 * 7653 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to 7654 * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling 7655 * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid. 7656 * 7657 * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in 7658 * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(), 7659 * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the 7660 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done 7661 * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool 7662 * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You 7663 * must not modify the skb in any other way. 7664 * 7665 * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return 7666 * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation. 7667 * 7668 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 7669 */ 7670 static inline struct sk_buff * 7671 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen) 7672 { 7673 return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 7674 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen); 7675 } 7676 7677 /** 7678 * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb 7679 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 7680 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() 7681 * 7682 * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing 7683 * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return 7684 * the error code. Note that this function consumes the skb 7685 * regardless of the return value. 7686 * 7687 * Return: An error code or 0 on success. 7688 */ 7689 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb) 7690 { 7691 return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb); 7692 } 7693 7694 /** 7695 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event 7696 * @wiphy: the wiphy 7697 * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will 7698 * be put into the skb 7699 * @gfp: allocation flags 7700 * 7701 * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the 7702 * testmode multicast group. 7703 * 7704 * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with 7705 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As 7706 * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the 7707 * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb 7708 * in any other way. 7709 * 7710 * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the 7711 * skb to send the event. 7712 * 7713 * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen. 7714 */ 7715 static inline struct sk_buff * 7716 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp) 7717 { 7718 return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE, 7719 NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1, 7720 approxlen, gfp); 7721 } 7722 7723 /** 7724 * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event 7725 * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with 7726 * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb() 7727 * @gfp: allocation flags 7728 * 7729 * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated 7730 * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always 7731 * consumes it. 7732 */ 7733 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp) 7734 { 7735 __cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp); 7736 } 7737 7738 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) .testmode_cmd = (cmd), 7739 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) .testmode_dump = (cmd), 7740 #else 7741 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd) 7742 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd) 7743 #endif 7744 7745 /** 7746 * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params 7747 * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL) 7748 * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets 7749 * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in 7750 * @erp_next_seq_num is valid. 7751 * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in 7752 * FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the 7753 * status for a FILS connection. 7754 * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL). 7755 * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets 7756 * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID 7757 * used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL). 7758 */ 7759 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params { 7760 const u8 *kek; 7761 size_t kek_len; 7762 bool update_erp_next_seq_num; 7763 u16 erp_next_seq_num; 7764 const u8 *pmk; 7765 size_t pmk_len; 7766 const u8 *pmkid; 7767 }; 7768 7769 /** 7770 * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params 7771 * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 7772 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 7773 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 7774 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 7775 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 7776 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 7777 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 7778 * case. 7779 * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL) 7780 * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length 7781 * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7782 * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length 7783 * @fils: FILS connection response parameters. 7784 * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 7785 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 7786 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 7787 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 7788 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 7789 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 7790 * @valid_links: For MLO connection, BIT mask of the valid link ids. Otherwise 7791 * zero. 7792 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO connection, MLD address of the AP. Otherwise %NULL. 7793 * @links : For MLO connection, contains link info for the valid links indicated 7794 * using @valid_links. For non-MLO connection, links[0] contains the 7795 * connected AP info. 7796 * @links.addr: For MLO connection, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise 7797 * %NULL. 7798 * @links.bssid: For MLO connection, MAC address of the AP link. For non-MLO 7799 * connection, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL). 7800 * @links.bss: For MLO connection, entry of bss to which STA link is connected. 7801 * For non-MLO connection, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to which STA 7802 * is connected. It can be obtained through cfg80211_get_bss() (may be 7803 * %NULL). It is recommended to store the bss from the connect_request and 7804 * hold a reference to it and return through this param to avoid a warning 7805 * if the bss is expired during the connection, esp. for those drivers 7806 * implementing connect op. Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs 7807 * to be specified. 7808 * @links.status: per-link status code, to report a status code that's not 7809 * %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for a given link, it must also be in the 7810 * @valid_links bitmap and may have a BSS pointer (which is then released) 7811 */ 7812 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params { 7813 int status; 7814 const u8 *req_ie; 7815 size_t req_ie_len; 7816 const u8 *resp_ie; 7817 size_t resp_ie_len; 7818 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 7819 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason; 7820 7821 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 7822 u16 valid_links; 7823 struct { 7824 const u8 *addr; 7825 const u8 *bssid; 7826 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 7827 u16 status; 7828 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 7829 }; 7830 7831 /** 7832 * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result 7833 * 7834 * @dev: network device 7835 * @params: connection response parameters 7836 * @gfp: allocation flags 7837 * 7838 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 7839 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 7840 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response 7841 * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), 7842 * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(), 7843 * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7844 */ 7845 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev, 7846 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params, 7847 gfp_t gfp); 7848 7849 /** 7850 * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result 7851 * 7852 * @dev: network device 7853 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7854 * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through 7855 * cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the 7856 * bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return 7857 * through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the 7858 * connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op. 7859 * Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified. 7860 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7861 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7862 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7863 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7864 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 7865 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 7866 * the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a 7867 * failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame 7868 * from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to 7869 * indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code. 7870 * @timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that 7871 * case. 7872 * @gfp: allocation flags 7873 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the 7874 * connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from 7875 * the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is 7876 * not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the 7877 * failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP. 7878 * This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0). 7879 * 7880 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 7881 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 7882 * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss 7883 * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among 7884 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 7885 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7886 */ 7887 static inline void 7888 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7889 struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie, 7890 size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie, 7891 size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp, 7892 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 7893 { 7894 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params; 7895 7896 memset(¶ms, 0, sizeof(params)); 7897 params.status = status; 7898 params.links[0].bssid = bssid; 7899 params.links[0].bss = bss; 7900 params.req_ie = req_ie; 7901 params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len; 7902 params.resp_ie = resp_ie; 7903 params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len; 7904 params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason; 7905 7906 cfg80211_connect_done(dev, ¶ms, gfp); 7907 } 7908 7909 /** 7910 * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result 7911 * 7912 * @dev: network device 7913 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7914 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7915 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7916 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7917 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7918 * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use 7919 * %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you 7920 * the real status code for failures. 7921 * @gfp: allocation flags 7922 * 7923 * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection 7924 * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to 7925 * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only 7926 * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 7927 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7928 */ 7929 static inline void 7930 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7931 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, 7932 const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len, 7933 u16 status, gfp_t gfp) 7934 { 7935 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie, 7936 resp_ie_len, status, gfp, 7937 NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED); 7938 } 7939 7940 /** 7941 * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout 7942 * 7943 * @dev: network device 7944 * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP 7945 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7946 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7947 * @gfp: allocation flags 7948 * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. 7949 * 7950 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed 7951 * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was 7952 * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send 7953 * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while 7954 * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among 7955 * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(), 7956 * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called. 7957 */ 7958 static inline void 7959 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 7960 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp, 7961 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason) 7962 { 7963 cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1, 7964 gfp, timeout_reason); 7965 } 7966 7967 /** 7968 * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information 7969 * 7970 * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL) 7971 * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length 7972 * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL) 7973 * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length 7974 * @fils: FILS related roaming information. 7975 * @valid_links: For MLO roaming, BIT mask of the new valid links is set. 7976 * Otherwise zero. 7977 * @ap_mld_addr: For MLO roaming, MLD address of the new AP. Otherwise %NULL. 7978 * @links : For MLO roaming, contains new link info for the valid links set in 7979 * @valid_links. For non-MLO roaming, links[0] contains the new AP info. 7980 * @links.addr: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the STA link. Otherwise %NULL. 7981 * @links.bssid: For MLO roaming, MAC address of the new AP link. For non-MLO 7982 * roaming, links[0].bssid points to the BSSID of the new AP. May be 7983 * %NULL if %links.bss is set. 7984 * @links.channel: the channel of the new AP. 7985 * @links.bss: For MLO roaming, entry of new bss to which STA link got 7986 * roamed. For non-MLO roaming, links[0].bss points to entry of bss to 7987 * which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %links.bssid is set) 7988 */ 7989 struct cfg80211_roam_info { 7990 const u8 *req_ie; 7991 size_t req_ie_len; 7992 const u8 *resp_ie; 7993 size_t resp_ie_len; 7994 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils; 7995 7996 const u8 *ap_mld_addr; 7997 u16 valid_links; 7998 struct { 7999 const u8 *addr; 8000 const u8 *bssid; 8001 struct ieee80211_channel *channel; 8002 struct cfg80211_bss *bss; 8003 } links[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]; 8004 }; 8005 8006 /** 8007 * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming 8008 * 8009 * @dev: network device 8010 * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info. 8011 * @gfp: allocation flags 8012 * 8013 * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the 8014 * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry. 8015 * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP 8016 * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in 8017 * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where 8018 * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the 8019 * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling 8020 * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released 8021 * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be 8022 * released while disconnecting from the current bss. 8023 */ 8024 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info, 8025 gfp_t gfp); 8026 8027 /** 8028 * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association 8029 * 8030 * @dev: network device 8031 * @peer_addr: BSSID of the AP/P2P GO in case of STA/GC or STA/GC MAC address 8032 * in case of AP/P2P GO 8033 * @td_bitmap: transition disable policy 8034 * @td_bitmap_len: Length of transition disable policy 8035 * @gfp: allocation flags 8036 * 8037 * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake 8038 * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e., 8039 * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function 8040 * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(), 8041 * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to 8042 * indicate the 802.11 association. 8043 * This function can also be called by AP/P2P GO driver that supports 8044 * authentication offload. In this case the peer_mac passed is that of 8045 * associated STA/GC. 8046 */ 8047 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer_addr, 8048 const u8* td_bitmap, u8 td_bitmap_len, gfp_t gfp); 8049 8050 /** 8051 * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped 8052 * 8053 * @dev: network device 8054 * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL) 8055 * @ie_len: length of IEs 8056 * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown 8057 * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally 8058 * @gfp: allocation flags 8059 * 8060 * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state 8061 * and not try to connect to any AP any more. 8062 */ 8063 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason, 8064 const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len, 8065 bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp); 8066 8067 /** 8068 * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start 8069 * @wdev: wireless device 8070 * @cookie: the request cookie 8071 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 8072 * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the 8073 * channel 8074 * @gfp: allocation flags 8075 */ 8076 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 8077 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 8078 unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp); 8079 8080 /** 8081 * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired 8082 * @wdev: wireless device 8083 * @cookie: the request cookie 8084 * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request) 8085 * @gfp: allocation flags 8086 */ 8087 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 8088 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, 8089 gfp_t gfp); 8090 8091 /** 8092 * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired 8093 * @wdev: wireless device 8094 * @cookie: the requested cookie 8095 * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request) 8096 * @gfp: allocation flags 8097 */ 8098 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 8099 struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp); 8100 8101 /** 8102 * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics. 8103 * 8104 * @sinfo: the station information 8105 * @gfp: allocation flags 8106 */ 8107 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 8108 8109 /** 8110 * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info 8111 * @sinfo: the station information 8112 * 8113 * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station 8114 * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on 8115 * the stack.) 8116 */ 8117 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo) 8118 { 8119 kfree(sinfo->pertid); 8120 } 8121 8122 /** 8123 * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station 8124 * 8125 * @dev: the netdev 8126 * @mac_addr: the station's address 8127 * @sinfo: the station information 8128 * @gfp: allocation flags 8129 */ 8130 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 8131 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 8132 8133 /** 8134 * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station 8135 * @dev: the netdev 8136 * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used. 8137 * @sinfo: the station information/statistics 8138 * @gfp: allocation flags 8139 */ 8140 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 8141 struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp); 8142 8143 /** 8144 * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station 8145 * 8146 * @dev: the netdev 8147 * @mac_addr: the station's address. For MLD station, MLD address is used. 8148 * @gfp: allocation flags 8149 */ 8150 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev, 8151 const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp) 8152 { 8153 cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp); 8154 } 8155 8156 /** 8157 * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification 8158 * 8159 * @dev: the netdev 8160 * @mac_addr: the station's address 8161 * @reason: the reason for connection failure 8162 * @gfp: allocation flags 8163 * 8164 * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station 8165 * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection 8166 * for some reasons, this function is called. 8167 * 8168 * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from 8169 * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum 8170 */ 8171 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr, 8172 enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason, 8173 gfp_t gfp); 8174 8175 /** 8176 * struct cfg80211_rx_info - received management frame info 8177 * 8178 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in kHz 8179 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 8180 * @have_link_id: indicates the frame was received on a link of 8181 * an MLD, i.e. the @link_id field is valid 8182 * @link_id: the ID of the link the frame was received on 8183 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 8184 * @len: length of the frame data 8185 * @flags: flags, as defined in &enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 8186 * @rx_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of frame RX in nanoseconds 8187 * @ack_tstamp: Hardware timestamp of ack TX in nanoseconds 8188 */ 8189 struct cfg80211_rx_info { 8190 int freq; 8191 int sig_dbm; 8192 bool have_link_id; 8193 u8 link_id; 8194 const u8 *buf; 8195 size_t len; 8196 u32 flags; 8197 u64 rx_tstamp; 8198 u64 ack_tstamp; 8199 }; 8200 8201 /** 8202 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext - management frame notification with extended info 8203 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8204 * @info: RX info as defined in struct cfg80211_rx_info 8205 * 8206 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 8207 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 8208 * 8209 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 8210 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 8211 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 8212 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 8213 */ 8214 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8215 struct cfg80211_rx_info *info); 8216 8217 /** 8218 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 8219 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8220 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz 8221 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 8222 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 8223 * @len: length of the frame data 8224 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 8225 * 8226 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 8227 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 8228 * 8229 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 8230 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 8231 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 8232 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 8233 */ 8234 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, 8235 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 8236 u32 flags) 8237 { 8238 struct cfg80211_rx_info info = { 8239 .freq = freq, 8240 .sig_dbm = sig_dbm, 8241 .buf = buf, 8242 .len = len, 8243 .flags = flags 8244 }; 8245 8246 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info); 8247 } 8248 8249 /** 8250 * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame 8251 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8252 * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz 8253 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 8254 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 8255 * @len: length of the frame data 8256 * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags 8257 * 8258 * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station 8259 * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel. 8260 * 8261 * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame. 8262 * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized 8263 * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the 8264 * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame. 8265 */ 8266 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, 8267 int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len, 8268 u32 flags) 8269 { 8270 struct cfg80211_rx_info info = { 8271 .freq = MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), 8272 .sig_dbm = sig_dbm, 8273 .buf = buf, 8274 .len = len, 8275 .flags = flags 8276 }; 8277 8278 return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_ext(wdev, &info); 8279 } 8280 8281 /** 8282 * struct cfg80211_tx_status - TX status for management frame information 8283 * 8284 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() 8285 * @tx_tstamp: hardware TX timestamp in nanoseconds 8286 * @ack_tstamp: hardware ack RX timestamp in nanoseconds 8287 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 8288 * @len: length of the frame data 8289 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 8290 */ 8291 struct cfg80211_tx_status { 8292 u64 cookie; 8293 u64 tx_tstamp; 8294 u64 ack_tstamp; 8295 const u8 *buf; 8296 size_t len; 8297 bool ack; 8298 }; 8299 8300 /** 8301 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext - TX status notification with extended info 8302 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8303 * @status: TX status data 8304 * @gfp: context flags 8305 * 8306 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be 8307 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the 8308 * transmission attempt with extended info. 8309 */ 8310 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8311 struct cfg80211_tx_status *status, gfp_t gfp); 8312 8313 /** 8314 * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame 8315 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8316 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() 8317 * @buf: Management frame (header + body) 8318 * @len: length of the frame data 8319 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 8320 * @gfp: context flags 8321 * 8322 * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be 8323 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the 8324 * transmission attempt. 8325 */ 8326 static inline void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8327 u64 cookie, const u8 *buf, 8328 size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp) 8329 { 8330 struct cfg80211_tx_status status = { 8331 .cookie = cookie, 8332 .buf = buf, 8333 .len = len, 8334 .ack = ack 8335 }; 8336 8337 cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status_ext(wdev, &status, gfp); 8338 } 8339 8340 /** 8341 * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control 8342 * port frames 8343 * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame 8344 * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() 8345 * @buf: Data frame (header + body) 8346 * @len: length of the frame data 8347 * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged 8348 * @gfp: context flags 8349 * 8350 * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be 8351 * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of 8352 * the transmission attempt. 8353 */ 8354 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie, 8355 const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, 8356 gfp_t gfp); 8357 8358 /** 8359 * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame 8360 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 8361 * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame. It is assumed that the skbuf 8362 * is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header). The skb can be non-linear. 8363 * This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is 8364 * responsible for any cleanup. The caller must also ensure that 8365 * skb->protocol is set appropriately. 8366 * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted 8367 * @link_id: the link the frame was received on, -1 if not applicable or unknown 8368 * 8369 * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port 8370 * frame. It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive 8371 * control port frames over nl80211. 8372 * 8373 * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all 8374 * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame). 8375 * 8376 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace 8377 */ 8378 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev, struct sk_buff *skb, 8379 bool unencrypted, int link_id); 8380 8381 /** 8382 * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event 8383 * @dev: network device 8384 * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event 8385 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available 8386 * @gfp: context flags 8387 * 8388 * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring 8389 * rssi threshold reached event occurs. 8390 */ 8391 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev, 8392 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event, 8393 s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp); 8394 8395 /** 8396 * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer 8397 * @dev: network device 8398 * @peer: peer's MAC address 8399 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold 8400 * but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent 8401 * threshold (to account for temporary interference) 8402 * @gfp: context flags 8403 */ 8404 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev, 8405 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp); 8406 8407 /** 8408 * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event 8409 * @dev: network device 8410 * @peer: peer's MAC address 8411 * @num_packets: how many packets were lost 8412 * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission 8413 * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached. 8414 * @gfp: context flags 8415 * 8416 * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a 8417 * given interval is exceeded. 8418 */ 8419 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 8420 u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp); 8421 8422 /** 8423 * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event 8424 * @dev: network device 8425 * @gfp: context flags 8426 * 8427 * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP. 8428 */ 8429 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp); 8430 8431 /** 8432 * __cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event 8433 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8434 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 8435 * @offchan: the radar has been detected on the offchannel chain 8436 * @gfp: context flags 8437 * 8438 * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl. 8439 */ 8440 void __cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8441 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8442 bool offchan, gfp_t gfp); 8443 8444 static inline void 8445 cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8446 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8447 gfp_t gfp) 8448 { 8449 __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, false, gfp); 8450 } 8451 8452 static inline void 8453 cfg80211_background_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8454 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8455 gfp_t gfp) 8456 { 8457 __cfg80211_radar_event(wiphy, chandef, true, gfp); 8458 } 8459 8460 /** 8461 * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event 8462 * @dev: network device 8463 * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified 8464 * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value 8465 * @gfp: context flags 8466 * 8467 * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action 8468 * frame. 8469 */ 8470 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac, 8471 struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode, 8472 gfp_t gfp); 8473 8474 /** 8475 * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event 8476 * @netdev: network device 8477 * @chandef: chandef for the current channel 8478 * @event: type of event 8479 * @gfp: context flags 8480 * 8481 * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished 8482 * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process, 8483 * also by full-MAC drivers. 8484 */ 8485 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev, 8486 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8487 enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp); 8488 8489 /** 8490 * cfg80211_background_cac_abort - Channel Availability Check offchan abort event 8491 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8492 * 8493 * This function is called by the driver when a Channel Availability Check 8494 * (CAC) is aborted by a offchannel dedicated chain. 8495 */ 8496 void cfg80211_background_cac_abort(struct wiphy *wiphy); 8497 8498 /** 8499 * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying 8500 * @dev: network device 8501 * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races) 8502 * @replay_ctr: new replay counter 8503 * @gfp: allocation flags 8504 */ 8505 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid, 8506 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp); 8507 8508 /** 8509 * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate 8510 * @dev: network device 8511 * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority) 8512 * @bssid: BSSID of AP 8513 * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication 8514 * @gfp: allocation flags 8515 */ 8516 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index, 8517 const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp); 8518 8519 /** 8520 * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame 8521 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 8522 * @addr: the transmitter address 8523 * @gfp: context flags 8524 * 8525 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 8526 * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the 8527 * sender. 8528 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 8529 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 8530 */ 8531 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev, 8532 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 8533 8534 /** 8535 * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame 8536 * @dev: The device the frame matched to 8537 * @addr: the transmitter address 8538 * @gfp: context flags 8539 * 8540 * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that 8541 * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected. 8542 * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each 8543 * station to avoid event flooding. 8544 * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed 8545 * for a reason other than not having a subscription.) 8546 */ 8547 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev, 8548 const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp); 8549 8550 /** 8551 * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status 8552 * @dev: the device the probe was sent on 8553 * @addr: the address of the peer 8554 * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously 8555 * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not 8556 * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame. 8557 * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not. 8558 * @gfp: allocation flags 8559 */ 8560 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr, 8561 u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal, 8562 bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp); 8563 8564 /** 8565 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs 8566 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 8567 * @frame: the frame 8568 * @len: length of the frame 8569 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz 8570 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 8571 * 8572 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 8573 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 8574 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 8575 */ 8576 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame, 8577 size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm); 8578 8579 /** 8580 * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs 8581 * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon 8582 * @frame: the frame 8583 * @len: length of the frame 8584 * @freq: frequency the frame was received on 8585 * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown 8586 * 8587 * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was 8588 * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no 8589 * netdev that is in AP/GO mode. 8590 */ 8591 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8592 const u8 *frame, size_t len, 8593 int freq, int sig_dbm) 8594 { 8595 cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), 8596 sig_dbm); 8597 } 8598 8599 /** 8600 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed 8601 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8602 * @chandef: the channel definition 8603 * @iftype: interface type 8604 * 8605 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 8606 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.) 8607 */ 8608 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8609 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8610 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 8611 8612 /** 8613 * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation 8614 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8615 * @chandef: the channel definition 8616 * @iftype: interface type 8617 * 8618 * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s) 8619 * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version 8620 * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under 8621 * more permissive conditions. 8622 * 8623 * Requires the wiphy mutex to be held. 8624 */ 8625 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8626 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8627 enum nl80211_iftype iftype); 8628 8629 /* 8630 * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace 8631 * @dev: the device which switched channels 8632 * @chandef: the new channel definition 8633 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO 8634 * @punct_bitmap: the new puncturing bitmap 8635 * 8636 * Caller must hold wiphy mutex, therefore must only be called from sleepable 8637 * driver context! 8638 */ 8639 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev, 8640 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8641 unsigned int link_id, u16 punct_bitmap); 8642 8643 /* 8644 * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start 8645 * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started 8646 * @chandef: the future channel definition 8647 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, must be 0 for non-MLO 8648 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens 8649 * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP 8650 * @punct_bitmap: the future puncturing bitmap 8651 * 8652 * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just 8653 * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting 8654 * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary. 8655 */ 8656 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, 8657 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8658 unsigned int link_id, u8 count, 8659 bool quiet, u16 punct_bitmap); 8660 8661 /** 8662 * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band 8663 * 8664 * @operating_class: the operating class to convert 8665 * @band: band pointer to fill 8666 * 8667 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 8668 */ 8669 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class, 8670 enum nl80211_band *band); 8671 8672 /** 8673 * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class 8674 * 8675 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 8676 * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class 8677 * 8678 * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise. 8679 */ 8680 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, 8681 u8 *op_class); 8682 8683 /** 8684 * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz 8685 * 8686 * @chandef: the chandef to convert 8687 * 8688 * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz. 8689 */ 8690 static inline u32 8691 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef) 8692 { 8693 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset; 8694 } 8695 8696 /* 8697 * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation 8698 * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested 8699 * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device 8700 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or 8701 * NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN) 8702 * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request 8703 * @gfp: allocation flags 8704 * 8705 * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that 8706 * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP 8707 * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use 8708 * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g., 8709 * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer). 8710 */ 8711 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer, 8712 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper, 8713 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp); 8714 8715 /* 8716 * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units) 8717 * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from 8718 * 8719 * return 0 if MCS index >= 32 8720 */ 8721 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate); 8722 8723 /** 8724 * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev 8725 * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove 8726 * 8727 * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary 8728 * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device 8729 * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called 8730 * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device 8731 * is unbound from the driver. 8732 * 8733 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 8734 */ 8735 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev); 8736 8737 /** 8738 * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev 8739 * @dev: the netdev to register 8740 * 8741 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather 8742 * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is 8743 * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable 8744 * instead as well. 8745 * 8746 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 8747 */ 8748 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev); 8749 8750 /** 8751 * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev 8752 * @dev: the netdev to register 8753 * 8754 * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather 8755 * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL 8756 * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are 8757 * usable instead as well. 8758 * 8759 * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held. 8760 */ 8761 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev) 8762 { 8763 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211) 8764 cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr); 8765 #endif 8766 } 8767 8768 /** 8769 * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements 8770 * @ies: FT IEs 8771 * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes 8772 * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address 8773 * @ric_ies: RIC IE 8774 * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes 8775 */ 8776 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params { 8777 const u8 *ies; 8778 size_t ies_len; 8779 const u8 *target_ap; 8780 const u8 *ric_ies; 8781 size_t ric_ies_len; 8782 }; 8783 8784 /** 8785 * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE 8786 * @netdev: network device 8787 * @ft_event: IE information 8788 */ 8789 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev, 8790 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event); 8791 8792 /** 8793 * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer 8794 * @ies: the input IE buffer 8795 * @len: the input length 8796 * @attr: the attribute ID to find 8797 * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g. 8798 * if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size 8799 * @bufsize: size of the output buffer 8800 * 8801 * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and 8802 * copies its contents to the given buffer. 8803 * 8804 * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is 8805 * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the 8806 * length of the found attribute (which can be zero). 8807 */ 8808 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len, 8809 enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr, 8810 u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize); 8811 8812 /** 8813 * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC) 8814 * @ies: the IE buffer 8815 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 8816 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 8817 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 8818 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 8819 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 8820 * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element 8821 * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array 8822 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 8823 * 8824 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 8825 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 8826 * split. 8827 * 8828 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 8829 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 8830 * 8831 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 8832 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 8833 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 8834 * 8835 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 8836 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 8837 * of the buffer should be used. 8838 */ 8839 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 8840 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, 8841 const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric, 8842 size_t offset); 8843 8844 /** 8845 * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering 8846 * @ies: the IE buffer 8847 * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer 8848 * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before 8849 * the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next 8850 * EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE. 8851 * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array 8852 * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer 8853 * 8854 * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset 8855 * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be 8856 * split. 8857 * 8858 * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this 8859 * has to be guaranteed by the caller! 8860 * 8861 * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered 8862 * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not 8863 * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering. 8864 * 8865 * The function returns the offset where the next part of the 8866 * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder) 8867 * of the buffer should be used. 8868 */ 8869 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen, 8870 const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset) 8871 { 8872 return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset); 8873 } 8874 8875 /** 8876 * ieee80211_fragment_element - fragment the last element in skb 8877 * @skb: The skbuf that the element was added to 8878 * @len_pos: Pointer to length of the element to fragment 8879 * @frag_id: The element ID to use for fragments 8880 * 8881 * This function fragments all data after @len_pos, adding fragmentation 8882 * elements with the given ID as appropriate. The SKB will grow in size 8883 * accordingly. 8884 */ 8885 void ieee80211_fragment_element(struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *len_pos, u8 frag_id); 8886 8887 /** 8888 * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN 8889 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup 8890 * @wakeup: the wakeup report 8891 * @gfp: allocation flags 8892 * 8893 * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it 8894 * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may 8895 * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something 8896 * else caused the wakeup. 8897 */ 8898 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8899 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup, 8900 gfp_t gfp); 8901 8902 /** 8903 * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver. 8904 * 8905 * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped. 8906 * @gfp: allocation flags 8907 * 8908 * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted 8909 * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given 8910 * by .crit_proto_start() has expired. 8911 */ 8912 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp); 8913 8914 /** 8915 * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has 8916 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8917 * 8918 * Return: the number of channels supported by the device. 8919 */ 8920 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy); 8921 8922 /** 8923 * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations 8924 * 8925 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8926 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 8927 * 8928 * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a 8929 * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to 8930 * the interface combinations. 8931 */ 8932 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8933 struct iface_combination_params *params); 8934 8935 /** 8936 * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations 8937 * 8938 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8939 * @params: the interface combinations parameter 8940 * @iter: function to call for each matching combination 8941 * @data: pointer to pass to iter function 8942 * 8943 * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible 8944 * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching 8945 * purposes. 8946 */ 8947 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8948 struct iface_combination_params *params, 8949 void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c, 8950 void *data), 8951 void *data); 8952 8953 /* 8954 * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection 8955 * 8956 * @wiphy: the wiphy 8957 * @wdev: wireless device 8958 * @gfp: context flags 8959 * 8960 * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA 8961 * disconnected. 8962 * 8963 * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous. 8964 */ 8965 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev, 8966 gfp_t gfp); 8967 8968 /** 8969 * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy 8970 * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down 8971 * 8972 * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by 8973 * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed). 8974 * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors 8975 * that really can't be recovered in any other way. 8976 * 8977 * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into 8978 * the driver while the function is running. 8979 */ 8980 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy); 8981 8982 /** 8983 * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag 8984 * 8985 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 8986 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 8987 * 8988 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 8989 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 8990 */ 8991 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, 8992 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 8993 { 8994 u8 *ft_byte; 8995 8996 ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 8997 *ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8); 8998 } 8999 9000 /** 9001 * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag 9002 * 9003 * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify. 9004 * @ftidx: extended feature bit index. 9005 * 9006 * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see 9007 * &struct wiphy.@ext_features) 9008 */ 9009 static inline bool 9010 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy, 9011 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx) 9012 { 9013 u8 ft_byte; 9014 9015 ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8]; 9016 return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0; 9017 } 9018 9019 /** 9020 * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function 9021 * @f: NAN function that should be freed 9022 * 9023 * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members. 9024 */ 9025 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f); 9026 9027 /** 9028 * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters 9029 * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is 9030 * %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber. 9031 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery 9032 * result. 9033 * If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up. 9034 * @inst_id: the local instance id 9035 * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function 9036 * @addr: the MAC address of the peer 9037 * @info_len: the length of the &info 9038 * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any) 9039 * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function 9040 */ 9041 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params { 9042 enum nl80211_nan_function_type type; 9043 u8 inst_id; 9044 u8 peer_inst_id; 9045 const u8 *addr; 9046 u8 info_len; 9047 const u8 *info; 9048 u64 cookie; 9049 }; 9050 9051 /** 9052 * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function. 9053 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 9054 * @match: match notification parameters 9055 * @gfp: allocation flags 9056 * 9057 * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This 9058 * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that 9059 * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received. 9060 */ 9061 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 9062 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp); 9063 9064 /** 9065 * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination. 9066 * 9067 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match 9068 * @inst_id: the local instance id 9069 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*) 9070 * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier 9071 * @gfp: allocation flags 9072 * 9073 * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated. 9074 */ 9075 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 9076 u8 inst_id, 9077 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason, 9078 u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp); 9079 9080 /* ethtool helper */ 9081 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info); 9082 9083 /** 9084 * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication 9085 * @netdev: network device 9086 * @params: External authentication parameters 9087 * @gfp: allocation flags 9088 * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error 9089 */ 9090 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev, 9091 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params, 9092 gfp_t gfp); 9093 9094 /** 9095 * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data 9096 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 9097 * @req: the original measurement request 9098 * @result: the result data 9099 * @gfp: allocation flags 9100 */ 9101 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 9102 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 9103 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result, 9104 gfp_t gfp); 9105 9106 /** 9107 * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed 9108 * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement 9109 * @req: the original measurement request 9110 * @gfp: allocation flags 9111 * 9112 * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this 9113 * the request pointer will no longer be valid. 9114 */ 9115 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev, 9116 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req, 9117 gfp_t gfp); 9118 9119 /** 9120 * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed 9121 * @wiphy: the wiphy 9122 * @iftype: interface type 9123 * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1' 9124 * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces 9125 * 9126 * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API 9127 * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when 9128 * check_swif is '1'. 9129 */ 9130 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype, 9131 bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif); 9132 9133 9134 /** 9135 * cfg80211_assoc_comeback - notification of association that was 9136 * temporarily rejected with a comeback 9137 * @netdev: network device 9138 * @ap_addr: AP (MLD) address that rejected the association 9139 * @timeout: timeout interval value TUs. 9140 * 9141 * this function may sleep. the caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex. 9142 */ 9143 void cfg80211_assoc_comeback(struct net_device *netdev, 9144 const u8 *ap_addr, u32 timeout); 9145 9146 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */ 9147 9148 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */ 9149 9150 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...) \ 9151 dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9152 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9153 dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9154 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9155 dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9156 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9157 dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9158 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9159 dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9160 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9161 dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9162 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9163 dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9164 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9165 dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9166 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9167 dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9168 9169 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9170 dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9171 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9172 dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9173 9174 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9175 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args) 9176 9177 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9178 dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args) 9179 9180 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG) 9181 #define wiphy_vdbg wiphy_dbg 9182 #else 9183 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9184 ({ \ 9185 if (0) \ 9186 wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args); \ 9187 0; \ 9188 }) 9189 #endif 9190 9191 /* 9192 * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference 9193 * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the 9194 * file/line information and a backtrace. 9195 */ 9196 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...) \ 9197 WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args); 9198 9199 /** 9200 * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space 9201 * @netdev: network device 9202 * @owe_info: peer's owe info 9203 * @gfp: allocation flags 9204 */ 9205 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev, 9206 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info, 9207 gfp_t gfp); 9208 9209 /** 9210 * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries 9211 * @wiphy: the wiphy 9212 */ 9213 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy); 9214 9215 /** 9216 * cfg80211_bss_color_notify - notify about bss color event 9217 * @dev: network device 9218 * @cmd: the actual event we want to notify 9219 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens 9220 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of 9221 */ 9222 int cfg80211_bss_color_notify(struct net_device *dev, 9223 enum nl80211_commands cmd, u8 count, 9224 u64 color_bitmap); 9225 9226 /** 9227 * cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify about bss color collision 9228 * @dev: network device 9229 * @color_bitmap: representations of the colors that the local BSS is aware of 9230 */ 9231 static inline int cfg80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct net_device *dev, 9232 u64 color_bitmap) 9233 { 9234 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_OBSS_COLOR_COLLISION, 9235 0, color_bitmap); 9236 } 9237 9238 /** 9239 * cfg80211_color_change_started_notify - notify color change start 9240 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched 9241 * @count: the number of TBTTs until the color change happens 9242 * 9243 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has started. 9244 */ 9245 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_started_notify(struct net_device *dev, 9246 u8 count) 9247 { 9248 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_STARTED, 9249 count, 0); 9250 } 9251 9252 /** 9253 * cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify - notify color change abort 9254 * @dev: the device on which the color is switched 9255 * 9256 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has aborted. 9257 */ 9258 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_aborted_notify(struct net_device *dev) 9259 { 9260 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_ABORTED, 9261 0, 0); 9262 } 9263 9264 /** 9265 * cfg80211_color_change_notify - notify color change completion 9266 * @dev: the device on which the color was switched 9267 * 9268 * Inform the userspace about the color change that has completed. 9269 */ 9270 static inline int cfg80211_color_change_notify(struct net_device *dev) 9271 { 9272 return cfg80211_bss_color_notify(dev, 9273 NL80211_CMD_COLOR_CHANGE_COMPLETED, 9274 0, 0); 9275 } 9276 9277 /** 9278 * cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap - validate puncturing bitmap 9279 * @bitmap: bitmap to be validated 9280 * @chandef: channel definition 9281 * 9282 * Validate the puncturing bitmap. 9283 * 9284 * Return: %true if the bitmap is valid. %false otherwise. 9285 */ 9286 bool cfg80211_valid_disable_subchannel_bitmap(u16 *bitmap, 9287 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef); 9288 9289 /** 9290 * cfg80211_links_removed - Notify about removed STA MLD setup links. 9291 * @dev: network device. 9292 * @link_mask: BIT mask of removed STA MLD setup link IDs. 9293 * 9294 * Inform cfg80211 and the userspace about removed STA MLD setup links due to 9295 * AP MLD removing the corresponding affiliated APs with Multi-Link 9296 * reconfiguration. Note that it's not valid to remove all links, in this 9297 * case disconnect instead. 9298 * Also note that the wdev mutex must be held. 9299 */ 9300 void cfg80211_links_removed(struct net_device *dev, u16 link_mask); 9301 9302 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_DEBUGFS 9303 /** 9304 * wiphy_locked_debugfs_read - do a locked read in debugfs 9305 * @wiphy: the wiphy to use 9306 * @file: the file being read 9307 * @buf: the buffer to fill and then read from 9308 * @bufsize: size of the buffer 9309 * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy to 9310 * @count: read count 9311 * @ppos: read position 9312 * @handler: the read handler to call (under wiphy lock) 9313 * @data: additional data to pass to the read handler 9314 */ 9315 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_read(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file, 9316 char *buf, size_t bufsize, 9317 char __user *userbuf, size_t count, 9318 loff_t *ppos, 9319 ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 9320 struct file *file, 9321 char *buf, 9322 size_t bufsize, 9323 void *data), 9324 void *data); 9325 9326 /** 9327 * wiphy_locked_debugfs_write - do a locked write in debugfs 9328 * @wiphy: the wiphy to use 9329 * @file: the file being written to 9330 * @buf: the buffer to copy the user data to 9331 * @bufsize: size of the buffer 9332 * @userbuf: the user buffer to copy from 9333 * @count: read count 9334 * @handler: the write handler to call (under wiphy lock) 9335 * @data: additional data to pass to the write handler 9336 */ 9337 ssize_t wiphy_locked_debugfs_write(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct file *file, 9338 char *buf, size_t bufsize, 9339 const char __user *userbuf, size_t count, 9340 ssize_t (*handler)(struct wiphy *wiphy, 9341 struct file *file, 9342 char *buf, 9343 size_t count, 9344 void *data), 9345 void *data); 9346 #endif 9347 9348 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */ 9349